2012-09-27 00:19:50 UTC
50632a7b06977 190.160.147.91 Chile
OF
MANUAL
PRACTICAL
HARMONY:
TO
GUDE
FBEPABBD
FOB
KSPEOIAIXT
CONSERVATORY
OF
STUDY
ITS
THl
MUSIC
AT
LEIPSIO.
BX
EENST
FEIEDRICH ORGANIST
UT7ST0-DTBE0T0B,
mnYEBSITY
m
STBUOTOR
TRANSLATED
OF
THB
THE
*
-
"
tW"
KUSIO.
GERMAN
EDITION
MUSIC,
AND
PUPIL
OF
THB
AUTHOR
EDITION.
"
"
"
"
*
^ "
"
""*""
NEW
G.
AlTD
" "
J
NIOOLAI,
MOKGAN, OF
FOURTEENTH ".
ST.
OF OF
LATEST
P.
OONSEBYATOBY
LEIPSIO
CHUBOH
THB
OONSEBYATOBY
JOHN
By ALUMNUS
OF
THB
U-ROM
EICHTER,
ScHiEMER,
35
Union
J
J
'
J
-J
""
J
J
"
t
J
YORK:
Squat?e
(West
Side).
'.r-r\
.n 1
Bntered,
to
aooordlng
G.
tlie
Clerk*s
Office
of
the
District
Goart
of Congress,
Act
in
the
"\ year
18#ft
Of
SCHIRMER,
of
the
United
Stotes
628951
for
the
Northern
Distrtet
of New
PRBFAOB.
TBANSLATOR'S
In offering
Harmonielehbb
been
et,
No
to become
Manual
nstructor
t is held
by
few
do
justice to
in
nd
no
than
reater The
A
ave The
of
original,
without
idea
hich
in that has
and
he
German
translator
the
f
of the
been
clauses enclosed
whole
work
or
many
must
been
course
more
of Leipsic
and
;
in what
shows
has
which
efficient labor
of
years
translation
^Every
:
"
how
knows
as
mens the im-
estimation
work
in
difficult
English
an
is at
who
exceedingly
definite
and
of exact
one
al
it is
translation English
terms
music. to
striven
add words
any
throughout,
give,
for the
embellishment a
preferred in
fuU,
to
square-cut
a
more
the sake
sentence
sense
exact
of
attractiveness
containing one
smoothly-rounded
something. which
necessary
seemed
in square
brackets.
been
performed
has
has
one
the
of
in Europe,
poverty
original or
one
which
success.
scientific
always
omit
would few
has
the
matter,
is the
science
as
public.
to
as
a
his
had
has
the
we
has,
which
road no
and
outUnes
during
musical
with
;
in the Conservatory
work
remarks
cquainted
the
the
author
to real
pupils
best
the
its
harmonist
contains,
the
that
saying,
of Harmony
text-hook
than
in Harmony
sale
in
hesitation
no
Biohteb's
of
world.
practical
itself the
roved
A
a
in leading
uccessful The
the
better
kaows
best
the
of
translation
this
pnbKc
have
need
to
given
one
ake
o
we
translation
a
offer
American
to the
as
a
for clearness,
pleasant
duty
to
a
v
tbanslatob's
the
to whom
eacher
f the
earnest
many
an
adequate^
preface.
translator
owes
all gratitude,
in this country,
students
pradiml
Manual
especially
due
are
who
of Harmony
and
in behall
utterly
out with-
Introduction
and
to
oimterpoint. Thanks
of Oberlin
which,
without
in
general,
anguage
een
D.,
D.
organ,
ork,
are
done
much
the
and
his
to
College, aid of
of the
his
father,
revered
for
his
kind
assistance knowledge
comprehensive
German
ia
particular,
York,
June
must
less accurately. JOHN
New
Bev.
IH,
1867.
P.
MOBaAN.
JoHK
in the
o have
The
the
with
into
put
ies of
such
ontain
the most
ressed
in
a
a
ttempts
at
The
book
the
There
clear
ther
nd
hat
o
features
no
as
part
the
the
as
in
The
these
possible
quali"
theory
h
reference
and
qualify for
to
eoo
must
there
;
by
order
o
It must
:
musical
accompanied
music,
explanation
be
to
connection
of
repetition.
of
complete
always
difficult to
has,
indeed,
the
that
no
understand in this
far
doubt
respect as
would
yet
by
blooming a
the an
want
entirely
basis,
of the
is foimd
late
now
in
system
and
as
much
supplying.
a
youth,
everything
it shrinks
to be
literature,
All
on
the
to know
knife,
it is not
musical
after
especially have
to
way.
inquire
anatomical
o
accessible,
scientific to
mony har-
on
dedicated
only
like to
art ; and
in
any
means
rules, would
hfe of
succeeded
is
abstractly
possible,
means
treatise
with
disposition
a
musical
be
case
scanty
in authority,
learning, the
the firm
in
been in
is a
attain
ever
belief
as
with
definiteness
to
theoretic
scientifically
upon
very
has
as
application^
practical
object, which
side,from
one
believes
hut
supported
athematical
pposed
author
fundamental
although
it is
be
for their
essential^
contains
he practical
would
and
theory
the
for
help
a
pupils
the
irief
in
o
composition.
but,
armony,
the
in
desirable,
was
studies
of
forward,
manner
to
uidance
course
of
It
boot
text
this
pubEshing
title.
the
man^al,
fundamental
hese
0
hands
brought
doctrines
he
in
practical
the
for
occasion
is indicated
armony
o
immediate
most
EDmON.
FIRST
THE
TO
PREFACE
THE
FROM
denied which
attempts
the
f
have
sort
as
system,
musical
always
inks
for the
things
musical
the
books
a
of
just
was
indubitable
ith
s
Still, rightly and
iper
however,
hat
his
as
to
immediate
to
education
must
to
above,
childish
mode
impor
musical verified
learned
tions, investiga-
in itself
complete
fanciful
structure,
is perceptible
likes
who
in
hitherto
a
the
immediate down
system as
to
*
deficiency
disadvantageous
so
a
understanding
most
single
in part,
basis.
musician,
of
serving
reference
however,
not,
create
and
this
regarded,
has
application
scientific
educated
ot,
basis,
into
connecting
abstract,
all the
laid
i
regard,
the
little
is
mathematician
divided
much
too
the
all, of
exhibited
this
of
with
What
conclusions,
without
utterly
in part,
it, still having
little able
as
whole,
musician.
it in part
tself, because
discovery
is, after
scientific
too
part,
objects, and in
which
with
ext
other
shown
musical,
roperly
of the
than
in
easy
the
allow
completion
itself less
usic
f
to
portions
in
foimd
philosophers,
accomplished
but
attention,
of
worthy
solated
have
what
cally scientifi-
fundamental
orm
are
realm
and
tenable
really through
musical
consequences,
physicists
a
create
to which,
in the
necessary
and
to
according
all phenomena
rinciple
ndeed
failed
yet
to busy
the
himself
in consequence
suffer
the
theory,
with
student
advancing
to
only
of
music
of it ; and
#
his
asure,
to
has
usic
tand-point, the
owards
;sked
is not
It may a
here
of
stage
apply
his
cost
him
it will
ecause
Why
?
Die
to
Natur
and
which a
real
call
he
trouble can
with
Here
of immediate
der Harmonik
to
a
Metrih
technical
the
attain
ease
greater
hy
for
M.
the
advance to
question
might
of
education, to
enough
which
questions
student
be
is. How
application
work
over
enough
advancing
his
to
certain
through
comprehensibly
The
a
from
which
of all things
artist.
attention
in
compared
procedure,
origin
power
time
the inquiry
permitted
of
answered
whole
of
position
be
might
education.
from
starting
be
be
can
seldom
questioner's
at the
get
would
curiosity, which
he
that
with
reat
*
referred
scepticism,
be
Hauptmann,
adapted
t
thing
to be
nderstand,
not
he
to
be
or
discovering
This
bservation
and
e destined
the
hints
in
In
closing,
ndeed,
but
It is
orks
of
our
to pluck
nd
prove
hat
the
atural
o that
horough than
an
the
goal
especially
them
an
harmony
of
exercises, out
carrying
same
distant
of
al
beginning itself
o
low will fol
plan. art
of
;
an
one,
earnest
and
under
deceive
formations
beauty.
knowledge
less
(to
are
No attain
of
could
person
which
of
the
of
think
to
has be
the
over
or
the to
be
know
opinion
that
develop
talent
to
erroneous
itself
never
was,
capable
mind,
material,
of
to
thoroughly
extends the
principles,
filled with
who,
poetic
product
enduring
structures
learning
which
latter
a
with
; who
dissection the
musical
into
without
beauty
of
of
the
actual
exercised,
themselves,
gifted
aids
the
vigorously
recognized
blossoms,
consecration
a
is the
; this goal
comprehend
technical
requisite
this
masters,
the
to the
doctrine
to
since
contained
for
counterpoint
the
from
and
obtain
extend
disciple
For
to
won
great
the
suffers
a
bitterly
will
ble
art
is
which
Those
manner,
the
give
resulting
through
ready
the
to
word
necessary,
ife.
for the
after
to
of performing
method
of
music.
perhaps
to
the
contains
volume
of art.
of works
that
form,
doctrine
to reach
object
is
a
wishing,
despised,
meant.
well
our
ctivity
im
still
; without
exercises
; the
later
a
truths,
edge knowl-
all
pains
clear
and
to let the
and
These
studies
at
,
rational
whole,
principles.
however,
f
the
of
simple
It
a
was
propositions
attractive
.for
ontrapuntal
orm
an
readers.
of
fixing
armonic
or
the
a
themselves
dress
with
omplete,
or the
for study
book
drde
xtended
in
to
it
require
to be
pertaining
author
of
aud
experience,
through
learned
the
principles
and
not
aid
t
models,
calling
why,
an
nature
of
in view,
aim
harmony,
of
n it, work
laws
the
be
will
certain
and
the
hsst
the
of
capability
experience
also
practical
xhibition
necessity
investigate
to
enough
from
obtained
the
acquirements,
time
from
experience,
calculate,
ater, if education,
t will
is, from
done
work
the
first
themselves ever,
sure,
without easier
to
PBEFAOE.
ill
the
s not
ill always
piritual
ust
skill, it is only
artistic
be
the
make thought
learned.
and
lse, it is of importance,
o
it iato
remodel
e
ttained
Qce
by
acquired
by
the
taking to
method
imitate
of works
apacity,
to
and
of art
certainly
the
recognize
the
to the
e,
goaL
skill
in
thought, manifold
them can
laws,
musical have
activity, of
wiU,
most
this
maturity,
in connection
must
only and
already
and for
the
anything
the
the
and
others
persevering
of hf
and
also,
what
development
capable lead
talent
extend
Earnest,
for
of
things
iq
which
with
with
to dissect
it
transform
comes
than
logically
were,
The
it is this
and
more
which
sensible.
if it often
music,
these
person
form,
Even
to
of
pains
discovered.
ational
forms,
new
knowledge
The
nner.
it
as
instinct,
the
of
education
the
without
consciousness
without
working
complete
itself, still, with
of
onception
do
the a
of
want
cannot
recognized
Exercise
thrive.
art
of
achievements
above the
with
be
endea
long
all, tion forma-
musical
a
FROM
THE
in
Although former
the
The
in
re
a
eed.
still let
works,
heory
friendly
manual,
hare
lately :
viz
des
which
OefneraUxisS'
WmMANN,
Benedict
und
since
admit
to
yielded as
of
in
A
and
Contrapunhtes,
by
in
bove
referred
my
of
the
so-called
text
my
for
general
to, and,
text
to
it for
using
more
book
has
me
indeed, book,
the
in
the
for
exercises
in part
aim
at
of
first
which, other
the
of
has
thorough-bass
itself too
this
following
doctrine
in
of
applications use
of
authors
study
first exercises
first
but
the
make
still the
proved
extended itself,
these
thorough-bass
the
the
to
Although
method,
rational end,
and
it.
particularly
to thank
work, to
more
speak
permitted
respect
more
farther,
be
to my
the
not
my as
ade
a
to
means
nowledge.
course
in
to
place
here
me
through
music
onnections,
he
Harmonie
the
reference
remarks
of
iguring,
is not
this
dditional
o
der
mateiial
instruction
of
appeared
by
Erlauterungen
received
o
necessary.
have
present
order
Hiller.
or their
ong
to the
Stvdium
zum
Although
hese
Kurzen
books
EDITION.
methodical
subjects
it seemed
where
related
the
still it has
many
some
THHID
also,
retained, for
last,
the
nebst
Uebungen
been
in number,
measure
Vebungen
edition
exercises
concerns
THE
TO
present
has
increased
As
the
ones
additions.
been
PREFACE
has
of in
excellent, harmonic
harmonic not
the
part
practice.
been works follow
The
X
PBEFAOE.
HiLLER,
of
work
follow
for
the
coiunse
Since
the
bnt
in order,
ay
here
when
ecame
part
erspicuity^
has
been
in that
This
introduced.
preceding,
edition
may
gain
time
text
book
of
I
may
If
in
to
order
"
ideal,
edition,
December^
for itself
that new
a
suggestive
both
the an
does beside
also,
fourth,
works
hope
of
and
simple
atd
improvement not
the
differ
old
additions,
if it fulfill that use,
the I
am
luminous
is still to
essentially
friends,
ones.
FEIEDB.
that
attain
possess, to
which
through to
must
venture
however,
I wish,
1863.
kind
many
be
edition,
expression,
reach
course
of
EDITION.
serviceable
EENST liEiPsro,
the
also
directions
is my
and
this
cati edu-
object.
fifth
after
fox
musical
in
only
material
alone
after them,
others
verbal
altered
many
which
epresentation
the
a
given
this
not
not
FIFTH
in
rich
theoretic
could
for this
THE
short
completely.
till conscious,
rom
a
through
which
its end
ook
in
necessary
in
to design
endeavor
my
book
professedly
a
kind,
of
part,
most
which
ofiEers in general
text
my
TO
been
exercises
manifold
recommended
PREFACE
has
most
needed,
highly
be
book,
for the
are,
the
for all branches
in
exercises
ay
It
the
of
and
besides text
my
exercises,
exhaustive,
w
of
elaborations
harmonic
e
however,
KICHTEB.
this
TABLE
];rTBODUGnoN."
OF
in^en^
"
CONTENTS.
I.
PAKT
HE
FUM)AMEin?AL
AM)
HABMONIES
18
"
"
"
THE
THEM.
FROM
DEBITED
CHOBDS
OBAPTKB
I.
"
n.
"
III. IV. V. VI.
VII.
"
Triads
of
the
Majob
Scale,
21
^The
Triads
of
the
MmoB
Scale,
40
^The
Inversion
^Harmonies
"
"
The
"
"
IX."
X."
of
^The
Chords
of
of
Seventh
Tone-degrees,
Chords
of
Chromatic
"
"
Seventh,
the
"
54
"
69
...
64
Seventh, .....
Chords
Secondary
the
Other
of
the
of
the
the
{yi"rldang^,
Chord
the
Harmonies
Inversion
47
Triads,
the
Seventh
the
Inversions
^The
On
of
of
Secondary
"
ViU.
The
connection
in
of
Seventh,
the
Chords
with
7?
.
of
81
Ninth,
Alteration
Eleventh
of
the
and
Fundamental
Thirteenth,
88
.
Harmonies.
tered Al-
91
Chords,
XL"
On
Modulation
of
Passage
a
Musio,
of
Xn."
OHOBD
FOBMATIONS.
TONES
Suspensions, .
Xm."
The
Organ-Point
"
"
.103
II.
PABT
OOIDEKTAL
"
TO
THE
HABMONT.
105
.
Stationary
FOBEIGN
Voices
^sa^
CONTENTS.
n
PAOV
APTSS
XIV." XV."
PAssma
Notes.
Passing
Chobds,
On
XVL"
Noms,
Modulation.
fob
APPLICATION
ill.
of
"
^Extension
XIX." XX.
XXI.
XXn.
"
the
On
Development
The
"
On
"
Development
On
Exebcises the
Habmonic
XIII."
.
of
176
188
Voices,
The
Six,
XVI."
On of
.
.
Movement,
"
.
"
.
Given
Voice
in
Seven
Devel-
IlIelodic
195
Musical
Movement, and
Fobms
203
.
Eight-voiced of
Close,
Movement,
"
"
"
Subjects^
"""i.S16
187
193
.
a
157
.
.
....
XXV."
ndex
Thbbe-voiced
Elabobation
Five-voiced
the
.
173
Accompaniment,
opment,
"
Voice,
Given
a
Movement,
Two-voiced
^The
XIV.
STEUCTUIUB.
Accompanying
the
the
in
HARMONIC
to
m
Melody,
of
of
.141
EXEBCISES
THE
Accompanimbnt Habmonic
the
188
"
"
HARMONIES.
PUBE
Habmonic
Simfly
XVII.^Thb
THE
THE
IN
"
III.
OP
USE
"
128
"
"
"
"
"
PAET
THEIR
"
"
"
Means
the
BAOnOAL
V
CHANama
"
206
.
"
"
213
INTRODUCTION.
Op
the
rovides,
and
eginning
of
in
the
brief
a
The
:
Theory
the
instruction
general be
must
mnsit
treated
the
at
in the
stands
be
will
in
presupposed
which
portion
Intervals^
of
of
nearest
rily prelimina-
manner.
condensed
and
wliicli
which
harmony,
of
study
for
with
acquaintance
it, viz
to
elation
knowledge
elementary
Intervals.
The
f
is called
pitch, The
to
espect
s reckoned
as
to
ccording Eemakk.
any
egree,
raajor
then
for
the
still, upon
to differenos*
in respect
another,
degrees
the
a
first degree,
lying
the
two
tones
that
the
higher
the
and
degrees
is understood
manner
to
according
the
in
stand, lowest
tone
is determined
between.
or
series
progression
tones
of
pre"
scale.
example,
being
the
the
determined
which
in such
rule,
of diatonic
minor
a,
is directly
staff, upon a
upon
number
or
as
and,
standing
take,
we
igher
other,
the
the
of
^By diatonic
"
by
nted
degrees
each
to
stands
difference
the
of
the
of
tone
one
Interval.
greatness
umber
If
in which
relation
sixth
g the
as
lower
higher,
tone,
will
situated
and
oome
the
upon
firs
the
upon
the
second,
0,
degriu .
6^
J^.
m The
numbers
of
manner
:
ollowing
the
12
*is: ig
.ig
degrees
produced
34
I % or
Prime.
Second.
"*""
Third.
thus,
"o.
-r^
Fourth.
"^
be
will
5
:8" Vnison
1^
6
78
-SL
"" "
-ftfc
F{fth"
in
expressed
"
-6^-
SiaOh.
-6^
Seventh,
'^
Octave*
the
As
a
tones
he
just
armony
however,
in
theory
and
tones
The
the
again
the
in
the
with
that
so
tho
fourth^
^
eleventh
octave^
now
then
and
the
sixteenth
from
the
designation
Eleventh.
the
octave
o
ing designat-
for
number
actual
o
upwards
fore, will, there-
FaurUenth.
Fifteenth.
:
ThirUenOi.
Twe^^
^
^
^
^
^
principles
occasion to
according
intervals
TsntK,
Mnth.
Octave.
explanation
octave,
double
following
the
receive
the of
series
their
give
general,
lie above
which
degrees.
:s:
lower
in the
^Particular
It is easy
to
that
see
diatonic
the
the
same
order
to
at
nd In
old
one
series
of
the
a
gain
of
of
Evert/
lter
their
them
Thus,
rela
be
of
well
to
first
the
in
forms
of
in
matter,
in
the
which
altered, appear.
mani :
principles
the lowest
intervals
These
intervals.
following
ure pleas-
these
of
midst
itself serves
series
at
be
would
rega
scale
themselves
the
the
carefully
above,
degrees
are
diatonic
be taken
can
degrees
the
they
the
of
tones
the
of
manner,
scale
the
of
the
tone
the
of
relations
like
In
thereby.
note
shown
that
is based
intervals,
the
the
tone
any
view
scale, which
is
tone as
are
firs
foundation called
majori
perfect.
alteration
chromatic
the lower,
their
IntervalSm
the
C, and
differences
intervals
major
them
-^
Octave.
to
reduced
of
the numbers
small
or all determinations
ome
simply
of
upon
that
clear
it will
variations,
Tlie
are
presentation
affected
whereby
time,
of
scale
based
as
tone,
above
not
it is conceivable lower
as
the
are
throughout,
hereas,
tones,
Determination
major
lie between
hich
two
-rt*-
S"oenih.
Siseih,
Fifth.
octave.
Mare
pon
between
distances
-^
-^
Fourth.
Third.
Second.
Greater
-^
-i^-
'^
"^
iun
of
the
series
octave,
thirds
a
becomes
find
which
$
of
fifteenth
the
new
each
with
tenth
the
second^
the
so
on
begin
and
octave^
so
and
above, a
the
again.
Keasons,
he
lie
to
only
becomes
;
on
so
cond
reckon
which
degree
inth
nd
we
rule,
not
these
the number
changing
designation,
of
but
only
tones,
of the a
renders
of
the upper
degrees,
more
tone
consequently
particular
as
well does
as
not
determination
necessary.
for
example,
if to
the
fifth
^
a
sharp
is in
any
way
attached,
i
:
ioD,
It has
unce
become
evidently
different fifth from
a
it
what
was
ig
of
nally. Or,
I
^fci^
i
Since
now
such
1. Seconds, scale,
thirds^ taking
If
If
upper
alf-step,
use
made
through
place
various
cally chromati-
definitely
more
and
of: and
sevenths
ninths^
for lower
tone,
from
the
which
result
called
major;
primes,
small
half-step,
are
perfect.
of
the
tone
of
intervals
major
[most]
diminished
major
intervals
augmented
lower
If the
following
take
be
lowered
a
result.
half-step,
mall 4.
the
tone
upper
intervals
inor
3.
the
the
Jlrst tone
ourths, fifths 2LTid octaves 2.
intervals
are
sixths,
its
of the
them,
designations
eterminative
ajor
lowering
or
raising
alterations
tone
of
most
intervals
and
intervals
perfect
be raised^
result.
intervals
minor
and
perfect
be
raised
result.
Tol. Major
Fer/eet
Major
I
Major
Perfect
-69-
-o-
^^
i^
^^
Second,
Third.
Fourth.
^^
^^
.^^
Siath.
F^th,
Seventh,
^^
if^
Octave,
ITinth,
2. Minor
Minor
I
Minor
;s 'l^
"^
Minor
"^"-
SMh,
Third,
Second,
Seventh.
mnth.
3. *
Atiffmented
Augmented
Augmented
I
Augmented
Prime,
Second,
Fourth,
Diminished
Diminished
Diminished
Augmented
""m
*
4* To
Major
:sz
Minor
To
Major
Perfect
12?: PHme,
To
Perfect
Fifth.
Siaih,
4. Diminished
'"^6
1^
M
r
JTiird,
^Augmented
Diminished
Fourth,
thirds, sevenths
Seventh,
F\fth.
and
ninths
do
r/"t
occur
in harmonic
Octave.
relations.
Aug
Rexabk.
oeivable,
^Dimimsbed
"
they
although
intervals,
progressing
reason
not
aised,
that
notwithstanding lies in the
will be
spoken
farther
View
General
a
of
of
Diminished
the
lower
the
if the
in regard
intervals
Classification
to
their
been
has
tone tone
upper
Most
the
of
P"XXB8.
lowered
were
inversion,
which
Intervals*
Used
Skookds. Minor,
Major.
Auffmented,
AufftnentecU
I
I ^
I DiminUhed,
3(inor,
$
m
"-
"?:
m
S
:ar
:^
Diminiahed,
Augmented,
PerfecL
3
"^
F
Sixths.
Fifths. Diminiahed,
Augmented,
Perfect,
I*-
Foubtos.
Thirds.
Ma^or,
i
Minor,
Major,
Attgmented,
"q=F==
I'-
I
i
Diminiahed,
Perfect,
m
"i.
of the
we
thereby, by
xpressed
tand
ertain
in
a
these
pure,
farther
indicate
atisfying
not
well two
of or
^=\ 3
connection a
farther
Consonances
into
consonant
I
but
relation
with
ones,
by
to
other
progression,
the
each
intervals, to
which, first,
other,
we.
be
we
does
the
without
stand undercan
be
such
as
sure,
understand
which ; by
intervals
and
Dissonancesm
and
dissonant
and
ill sounding
words,
satisfying
Minor,
r
Intervals
in music
speak
Major,
ISi
1^ JHvision
Ninths.
Ootavbb.
Diminiahed,
Minor.
m
:ki
.or.
Sf.ventus.
Major,
The
t
reference
on.
and
Per/set,
If
in
e.,
inoon
Intervale,
intervals, result,
would
all the
u
relations,
melodic
diminished
interval
harmonically
are
ninths,
and
together.
sound
the
of
like
relations
peculiar of
which
formation
in
of
Formation
the
on
sizihs
conceived
those
to
in the
why,
be
can
Remark The
seconds,
primes,
not
last, such
it would
a
require as
have
nitel defino
sense.
consonances
comprise
all those
intervals
called
perfect,and,
in ad"
The
first
The
dissonances
are
the
are
eventh,
and
all augmented
From
this
we
derive
following
second^
and
major
minwr
intervals.
diminished
and the
minor
and
m^jor
?ast incomplete.
the
consonances,
complete
called
:
plan
general
I. CONSONANCES.
Complete.
a.
The
perfect
fourth,
perfect
prim"j
5
octam.
perfect
jfifthand
perfect
8
I
i h. Incomplete.
The
major
and
third,
minor
I augmented
iminished
nd
ahed
diminished seventh,
the
ffth, the
diminished
^u(7m"n"""{
the
augmented
Minor.
JHmin,
major
and
|!?i." 2"imin.
^k(7.
second, the
5
dimin
and
minor
ninth.
3
i
^|g:-'Iti^.
the
augmented
minor
JHmin,
2
""
=5^r
4-
6
l^^^|^^^3
%=^ Major,
1 Minor,
Dimin,
r|"i
^i
"
I* in the
major,
Aug,
"
""".
^t"^.
*LBter
the
and
fourth,
the
sixth,
octave,
augmented
I "-^
I
and
diminished
and
"
i
minor
major,
Major,
1
I
DISSONANCES.
augmented the
sixth.
I
E
prim^e,
third,
minor
and
major
t. 5g" II.
The
the
and
iDstruction
in harmony,
7
Dimin,
8
Major,
Minor.
pZE
j=a
9
"
i* follows
a
fiEirther explanation
9f the
peooliar
Inversion
As a
s
was
rule,
he
of
d
he
called
intervals
lower
is dj
to
the
as
to
starting
fifth from
the
that
see
form
determine
the
point,
g^ however,
g ;
interval
the
an
interval
upper
particular
means
be
cannot
te al
this inversion
follow
inversion,
this
below
removed to
it may
of
of
be
is had
reference
explanation
will, by
scale
major
here.
the
assume
:
4
3
1
above:
I
Since
composition,
of
diatonic
if the
however,
tone.
kinds
n various
ntervals
tone
begin
we
bdow.
is easy
It
is occasion
there
upper
^^
'''
different,
original
ollowing
the
intervals
the
this.
becomes
The
are
fifth hdow.
the
by It
taking
Intervals,
determining
If, however,
tone.
tones,
for examp
in
above,
two
found
Thus,
rom
lower
the
with
relation
ntervals
indicated
already
tlie
(Venetssung) of
5
6
8
^^
3^.
gg^B
."fis: ""-
tervals
i^oto
There
:
7
8
result
thus,
6
the
following
12
is, through
:
numbers
4
5
6
7
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
inversion,
the
becomes
prime
an
the
octave,
a
second
"c.
eventh, The
of
3
8
hat
series
inversion
ollowing 1. All
the
of
in respect
to
forming
we
must
note
the
in
the
:
in
perfect
remain
basis,
the
intervals
all intermediate
intervals
PERFECT
scale
major
inversion
the
ctave,
2.
All
MINISHED,
In
the
become
intervals
MAJOR
and
the
following
diminished
table
bcinor,
aU
a
view
Pbuieb.
OBionvAi.
blTBBTALS.
biTSBSIOV.
I
jEs:
I
of
all the
inversions
:
Seconds. Augmented,
rziE
^
Minor,
Major. 122:
Augmented,
*
M
amzt'rziizrQ-
E Sktentds.
OOTATBS.
Perfeek
augmented
augmented.
is exhibited
Perfect
the
major,
minor
Diminished,
Minor,
Major, 3:
Diminished, lesn
V
m
FOUBTHS.
Thirds.
Diminished,
Minor,
Major,
Attffmented,
Fer/sct,
;tei
FUTTHS.
Diminished,
Perfect
Augmented,
3E*
pi
Auffmented,
-:sz
:;;"a
* 31
^
is:
Sixths.
FiKTus.
Diminished,
Augmented.
Minor.
Major,
uftf^mentad
^-
i
G-
i^-
-fi-
Sixths.
Major,
Perfect.
Diminished,
;e
ig:
I
.-".
Thibds.
Foctbths.
G-
Minor,
Augmented.
Diminished.
Perfect,
I
:""= i^^i
"
.-Q.
Major, ..O-
i^
:W
Sbvknths.
OOTATBS.
Minor.
Major,
Diminished,
Diminished,
P"}:Ak;"
Diminished.
K
ji
:":
II
""=^-1t Pbuibs.
Srconds. J^ftor.
l=? An
exact,
not
alone
acilitates
A
few
The
y
he
he
j^=^l^^
p"-
knowledge
certain important
their
more
s
;;a-
remarks
lowering
the
Since
by
upper,
the
fourth
augmented
:
#
to
here
follow
raising
is clearly
octave,
in
be
be
intervals
harmonic
must
greatly
for
structure,
recommended.
tone
seen
result
this formation
jj^z^giz
but
counterpoint,
simple
intervals
the
of
:
lower
the to
in double
of intervals,
first table
diminished
in the
inversion
fifth
in the
formed
were
insight,
is urgently may
inversion
this essential
exercises
and
study
why,
of
for the
comprehension
reason
ntervals
Augmented,
T
reason
hich
Major.
(page 16), all a
from from comes
of necessity
small the
above
the
of
half
diminished
step, and
table
through
augmented
itself;
give
of
not
sions. inver-
for
example.
the following
inish dim-
MANUAL
0
y
inversion
he
perfect
it is converted fifth
a
dissonance
ention
is made
oes
issonances, as
imply
kinds
no
Since
a
the
perfect
the
perfect
inversion
from
the
this
here
because,
the
fourth
be
fifth, in
the
fourth, of
in
a
theorists
manner
in the
cases
men
some
with to
times,
case
octav^
are
which
treatment
earlier
as
in any
never
consonance
similar
in
same
and
particular a
requires
some
different upon
complete
and
"
which
never
ezerM^rd
as
may
next
i
explain
be
t^nth over
passed
the
ninth,
helow.
intervals
in the
also
twelfth,
and here,
since
which
they
exerc
studies. ki"owledge
stadies,
Intervals, """
become
those
as
octave,
augmented can
such
certain
given
the
results,
our
harmonic
of
that
they
inversions,
influence
oral solution
clear
since
of
following
rolnpsiqn^
produce
HARMONY
dissonance.
entirely
roduce
into
induced
inverted,
Other
or the
on,
likewise
be
only
of
which a
It will
annot
can
result
farther
ioned
OF
the
will t^* ^e
of
all intervals
practice
of
facilitate
repeatedly
them much
is indispensable
in writing, their
employed.
correct
as
als" com-
HARMONY.
Combinations to
ccording
The
he
n
doctrine
kinds
of
right
and
the
ith
fundamental
certain
formed
tones,
simultaneous
are
principles,
different
from
in
called
intervalfl
chords,
the
us
makes
of
resolution,
the
This
treatment.
natural the
connection
different
the
with
acquainted
their
shows
and
natural,
transition,
the
harmony
of
chords
one
of
Among
the
oundation
of
AND
HARMONIES
those
a
definite
a
not
into
and
THE
CHORDS
DERIVED
a
plainly
ll remaining
two
chords
the
most
kinds
dent^ indepen-
as
distinguished
easily
other
harmonic
chords,
and
are
form
of
the
the
triads,
is formed is
called
by
the
to
fundamental
last the
chords
harmonies,
from
of the which
derived.
are
Triads
The
lowest
with
connection
I.
CHAPTER
triad
be
can
others,
with
the
themselves
present
which
for
serve
can
which
independent.
These
eventh.
those
connection
indicate
first belong
the
e,
is
THEM.
chords
of
composition,
which
herefore
kinds
various
without
dded,
that
I.
FROM
he
in
following.
FUNDAMENTAL
To
consists
chord
HE
oih
species
themselves,
among
commingling
PAET
A
Harmo*
general,
Chords,
ies^
nd
of
a
of
combination
fundamental
g.
"-l *
the
of tone,
Scale.
Major three to
different
which
tones.
its third
and
Of
these,
fifth are
triads, formed
These
intervals.
heir
hirds
c,
upon
While
the
triads
perfect jifths^the
2MdL
a,
g and
triad
c
of a
of
however,
present,
formed
are
g
and
a
contains
difference
a
here
by
majof
tJiirdBXi^
minor
U
as
perfec
ffth. A
triad
with
third
major
MAJOR
K
trisA
w\^
third
minor
As
^The
"
perfectfifth 9i,
9kvA
diatonic
the
oundation the
pon
the
of
scale
The
triad
mportant,
In
ts
until farther
key,
a
of
form
the
od.
forms
and
triads, which
the
also
will
follow
cannot
content so
scale,
Connection
the
one
the
connection
natural
the
founded
are
essential
of the
part
as
with
fifth
the
highest
as
meet
others
its position.
clear
tone,
the
however,
stand,
in thirds,
triad
the
of
is indeed
key,
a
; there
make
Key*
a
of
of
key
the
it, which
presentation
fundamental,
first step
the
determines
which
Triads
the
of
upon
rests
which
nearest
tself
the
up
the
of
triads
of
content.
Natural
n the
kinds
other
successions,
steps
,
TRIAD.
makes
melodic
different
armonic
of
explanation
a
TRIAD.
MINOR
REiCAaK.
is called
perfect ffth
zxA
lowest
the
shows
same
time
as
the
chord,
or
the
at
and
tone
culmination.
ft.
^fo^
*;
'"i
FundamsntaL
Each
farther tones
resent with
still, however,
ss,
be
nly
s
here
tanding
ifth of The
he
the
the
other,
connection
following
c
while
form
thus will
these
interval
would
The
next
in the
three
the
of
the same
chord,
in
c
and
of
form
the
would
which
chords
be
can
This
tones.
:
be most
its tone*
lie outside
fundamental
can
G, which
g.
the
tone
one
nearest
the
culmination,
F. plainly
presented
in
JQ.. .-t.
9.m F
connection,
viz
manner
of
its
of
in connection
standing
chord,
one
_,
losest
triad
alter
:
manner
It is especially
either
independent
an
itself upon
fundamental
the of
as
limits
outer
fifth, will
triad,
sure,
support
in the
found
be
to
new
doubled.
there,
already
this must,
a
of
addition
to
be remarked
that
their
tones
a
of these contaih
a
three
triads
all the
tones
which of
stand the
scale
in the ; that
lie those
itself clear
On
frequently
most
importance
their
of
The
them.
key
if the
practice,
to
is
piesent
distinct.
and
account
in
employed
first found,
one
been
first degree
the
upon
standing
have
names
also, especial
to
given
the scale, i
of
called THE
The
second,
fifth degree,
the
upon
third, upon
THE
If
we
they
three to
themselves
present
TRIAD.
SUB-DOMINANT
these
arrange
degree,
fourth
the
TRIAD.
DOMINANT
THE
The
TRIAD.
TOKTIO
chords thus
us
:
-"-
themselves
the
urselves Reuakk. in
oiced
theoretical
vement
for this
will
always
three,
be
maintain
Discovered*
be
can
a
its importance
well
detain
however,
reserved
later
of
we
chords,
ftvaU
writing.
combination
for
as
well
of
It would,
reason,
as
manner
chord
relation.
manifold
may,
and
im,
^The
"
four-voiced
the
of
these
of
triads.
major
Harmonies
the
of
application
as
collectively,
Application
In
v
IV
I
show
in the soalei
order
-"-
-""
they
their
I
4.
nd
to
according
longer
us
from
foundation
the
our
practieal
four-voieed
all kinds
of
thre^
sure,
The
presentation.
special as
to be
presented,
of
oom*
osition.
We
or the
our
piano-forte
alled
often
harmony
not
them,
present
tho
The the
the
Bass, of
arrangement triad
:
voices
outer
above
Soprano,
is called
upper
next
nd
each
as
divide
but
mass,
mere
a
as
compositions
its component
parts
two
together
into
differentvoices.
The
ne
however,
regard,
may
be
the
voice
Tenor; these
exhibited
the
lowest
next
below
these
voices
thus
two
in the :
Bass, the
together manner
these
Soprano are
of
is called cslled
a
score
Alto,
are
the
middle-voices. is
as
follows^
MANUAL
24 For
the, upper
to their
spoken
next
The
are
especial clefs
above* used
we
exercises,
bettei
confoxm
used, which
[G] clef, and
violin
staff for
for the piano,
(upon two
distribution
for the
select
separate
a
not
writing
the
HARMONY.
which
will
bo
later.
our
whole,
voices
than
compass
of
For
three
OF
voice, but will
each
of the
easier view the
use
form
usual
of
staves).
in No.
of voices
an
of
sake
5, may
be exhibited
thus
:
6.
^
bopraito. Alto.
TSNOR.
i^^i^^^^ j^~j_"^Zg
Bais. "
A
X.
ft-
-^
twofold
of these
consideration
relation to the progression to
voices, both
the remaining
The
ing
of each
of which
be pure
must
two
first in
:
place
in its relation
voice for itself alone, then
of the fulfillment of these
result
will take
voices
various
well-constructed
and
is called pure
conditions
lead
the voices.
of
This
out
seeking
harmony
of the
purity
and
the
practicing
is
its progression
and
natural
legitimate
and
through
attained of harmonic
com-
bination. Hereby style, which
later free
harmonic and
would sense,
Inasmuch
"
means
more
nearly
structure^
speaking,
as
the taste
and
term
under and better
harmonic indicated
antithesis
can
of the pure
By
the
for
sense
as
the
be used structure,
therefron^
resulting
harmonic
being
a we
matter
as,
in
of
a
In
cuarse.
of like
in distinction
is (pui-ity
struuiure
understand
expression
such
thxt"ugh
jsell^
As
of the pure was
of
for
a
the true
mous synony-
general a
more
\x)free"^^/tf,whereas,
perhaps,
correct
sense,
narrow
Htrict harmonic
meaning,
impure
a
here
farther, which
something
structure,
it were the latter in fact may occur, since, as frequently as assumed, be free designated 2A false, structure essentially founded might while the mate
nature
the pure
%n
exercises
exhibit
should
pure
structure
by
the
purified.
the purity
explanation,
called strict
also from
proceed
sharpened,
composition
every
strict style, since this no
judgment
expression), pure
which
for composition.
the
farther
no
require however,
and
at command
natural
with
is
formed,
correct
of all
is the
structure^
will afford the safest foundation
of which
materials
structure
Remark. use
of the
use
laws
rules and
prescribes
itself, the observance
music
harmonic
arises the so-called pure
properly is to be
certainly to be upon the Ugiii^
structure.
indicated
above,
by pure
harmonic
structureia
understood
in
a
narrower
sensi^
aoD
a
If,
in
still its boundaries
ay,
are
ater
to omit
ones,
ents.
Whether
tself with
ature,
all who
ill
have
to go
to
onformed
so
be
much
the The
morbidity
of
justifiedin making
n the
of the
works
o produce
masters,
not
busy
willingly before
creation,
anything,
been the
the
really
of mind. to
given
where
the
the
principles, is
nde
done
be
to
lawless
concerned
is to work
;
out
apparent
pupil
any
cannot
found
be
perhaps in
or,
basis
frequently
conceits
may
which
but
a
upon
the
as
them,
itself
hand,
other
them,
for future
to
power,
to make
able
most
On
freedom
forbidden
living
more
to
studies
their
is
which a
ever
whereas
their that
assured,
with
has
thing
the
when
its inci
from
produce
conform
that
of
mastery
of exceptions
greatest
compositions,
school,
weakness
and
use
be
means
bounds,
prescribed
can
creation,
and
fully, and
real
living
some
style ; indeed,
strict
does
which
bj
especially
harmony
of
premature
for
this book
by
more
of
genera
determined
them, the
a
rise to th
giyes
Tariously of
laws
in
here.
strict
lost
yery
impatience,
towards
of
a
point which
many
the
teach
capability
a
so
fundamentaJL
is determined
construction,
pure
youthful
views
means
within
proof
the
through
nature.
genially
urnish
no
itself
unfold
st
follow
are
occasioned
and
investigated
further
who
will
to
itself to the
be
by
of
inclination
this
abstract,
not
those
reation
indulgence
developed
need
Let
speak
the
composition,
with
this
the
has
rganic
lso
entirely
immediately
begin
o
to
is essential^
which
this is
fetoestdigressions
the
allows
Btructure
just
and
;
difficulty has
This
that
touch
boundaries
the
as
relations,
harmonic
yet drawn
not
themselves.
theorists
he
do not
pure
of
beginner,
difficulties for the
re
idea
the
all tone
of
as
such
only
and
precedes,
-what
development
the natural
the legitimate^
rom
e
in
aa
une
case,
to wish
theoretically
exercises
elL
The
three
ovement,
will
give
Since
the
triads
hereof,
must
be
The
dapted
atter, in many In
order
s to be
If
a
cases
to
tone
o be retained
which
7.
to
will
be
one
be
Triad
the shown
connection
part
in four-voiced
be
presents
itself
two
writing.
to
triads,
the
as
third,
and
(interva
Doubled,
later, is not of
which
established.
can
fifth
from
observations,
component
used
four-voice*
the
and,
be the
tone
most
indeed,
doubled following
at
the
all
rule
;
in
occurs in
tones,
usually rarely
the
accomplish
observed
the
of
more
are
be
to
are
in
applied and
remarks
three
however,
doubling,
being
rules
and
if they
doubled,
fundamental, for
for
contain
only
Interval
Any
known,
occasion features
fundamental
ertain
far
thus
chords
the
both same
of voice,
two
chords e.
g.
which
are
to he cminected,
it
ti
Id the Example
hich
n
t
Example The
in
in
In
two
OCTAVES.
order
to
to
nce
each
tone
appears,
none
the
Movement
the
of
can
voice
with
progress
of
we
exactly, the
of
parallel
motion,
S.
in
Voices
the
Hespect
{motus
rectus),
{motus
contrarius) and
voices
or
rise
fall at the
15"
g:
I
one
rises and
the other
falls,
g
i 22:
^ f
r
r
motion
the
if the
motion
IJ
Z=5t=I^.
oblique
".
-"-
"
-l
""I
y
I
in contrary
4
",
St
t=F
f
-"-
progress
to
time,
same
-"-
while
in refer*
voices
{m^tu^ obliquus).
motion,
g-
"
-"
They
firs
mast
4-
"
I ^.
in
other
in
another
arises, if two
motion
parallel
4
10.
independently
are
other.
[direct]motion
Obliqice
one
movement
as
other.
Contrary
The
any
more
to them^
"c.
voices
with
progression of
F,
so
connection.
lie nearest
the
appears
explanation
Parallel
The
to
Jnst
chord.
next
the
which E
from
each
One
tones
the
the
afiects
Tenor
fanlty
this
explain
Relation
Ttie
the
that
necessary
to
common
munner,
or
the
ake
a
A,
to
Alto
of
; the Soprano^
tone
common
as
fifth
as
of the
proceed
no
chords
such
IFTHS
G
triads
it also
O
the
voices
from
Alto
the
If
ed
in which
b^
remaining
a
in both
occurs
first C, retains
the
gare
C
a^
other
arises, moves
if, of
on,
e,
two
^
f-fone
voices
remains
npon
the
g.
i=J: 2^,
:y
:e:
"
"
3
a
:e:
f
i ISi'.
ik^^
I
-"-
^
same
These
kinds
three
vkmixed
tself between
enor
ng
Soprano
Bass,
and
in Example
Thus,
manner.
Tenor,
and the
and
the
of
movement
of
7, ", the
No. the
oblique
motion
faulty
movement
in chord
occur
voices
contrary
parallel
Alto
the
shows
motion
between
motion
between
connections
Soprano, the
and
remain*
voices.
The
mentioned
above
fifths^ can
nd
oices
only
by
progress
in
appear
degrees
or
in the
if, for
:
following
I
two
:
"
-G-
-Q-
octaves
example,
manner
-JS?.
11
in parallel
voices
motion
parallel
skips
the
of
"1^^^ favilt \%
This The
as
regarded
following
for all voices.
such
connections
harmony
of
both
contain
faults
:
b.
"h
i
^^^E
12.
9i:
In
Example
xample
Tenor
enor,
as
The
best
;
oices
hord
on
ve
the
pplied,
the
the
Cf e,
voice
tone,
same
tones
contrary
of the
12,
a,
motion
of
and
found
in
motion
all voices
13.
JS. Q
an
~^~~^
Soprano
and
or,
other
in respect
to to
Ij^j ^
one
the
following
voices
to
the
fifth with
if the
lie nearest
in respect
is, for
of
or
octave
The
2$
c,
Alto
movement
g.
I
between
a,
progressions,
mction^
which
in Example
in
Bass.
oblique
stationary.
Bass';
and
between
faulty
forms
harmony
oblique
Bass,
and
and
it in contrary remain
Soprano
in c,
similar
already
new
the
and
contrary
which
with
and
Soprano
between
the
of
move
in Example
Thus and
to
the
either
contains
use
and to be
are
Bass,
these
avoid
Alto
fifths and
time
same
the
is,
that
Parallel
between
skips
between
Tenor
to
meansj
must
nother,
the
cases,
above
Bass.
between
at
also
octave
parallel
progressions
and
; in b,
Bass
he
are
b, octave
etween
nd
a,
m
m^:
then
them. voice,
Bass,
and
at
\a to be
Rehabk.
he
^The
"
in unison,
progression
t is
the
as
w,
much
pains
following
he
If
each
in a
circle^
hat
so
two
ach
This
be
itself
for
is bounded as
seventh,
of
the
and
of
On
o
the
voices
in
fift
times
earliest
definitely.
are
placed if
observed
we
separate it
as
something
unti
point, le
this
can
only
itself into
resolves
by
side, will
here
be
produced
by
this
the
not
^h
and
int
taken that
:
it is
; then
other
one
evident,
int
themselves
resolve
to
relation
without
appear
following
the
compare
cannot
fifth, do
fifth after
side
be
formed
its fundamental
by
were,
let it be
which,
whole^
additional
harmony
boundaries,
their
a
mainly,
into and
over
goes
if they
can
express
presents
connections
with
but,
other,
each
:
examples
a.
The
however,
sevenths, idea the
ntimate
a
of
now,
boundary
; the
chords,
the
where
circle of the to
and
do
nor
chords,
original
the
make
ttoo
of
the
as
additional,
succession
perfect
only
(aoeordi
cate indi
to
serve
harmonies
the
of
lie,
they
and
chord,
connections
it will
fifth appears, the
of
constituents
remaining
anything the
of
two
of
new
properly,
of the
S
t^
more
firmer.
and
Everywhere
ss
form,
neither
seventh),outside
relations
ifth),or
I
p
""
o the
n
speak,
chords
ther.
f
to
of
from
that
ected
of the progression
it ; and
it clearly
ton*
independence
necessary
prohibition
necessity
is
whi"!h
examined.
(the
if the
the
of
in the
for the
ground
to
taken
respects,
other
ccount),and
hord,
be
view
by
as
been
chord-formation
it may
ifth,
has
the
with
octaves^
of
found
easily
be
may
conviction
prohibition
be
can
discover
difficult to
more
trong
for the
reason
seventh,
chord,
may
perfectfifths will
(as
lie above
be
always
in itself its character
carry it
the
were
below
or
discoverable
of
content
it ; the
in
the
unpleasant'
deficien
the
connection.
Since
hat
have
we
in the
case
in
of
onnection e.
be
be
to
one
perfect to
perfect
part, of
rogression
ollowing
here
spoken
fifths
sure,
fifths of
which
arise
since
this
will
from
forms
which
last
the
cause
lies only
a
the
in the
it may
triads
only,
added
sevenths,
fifths, of
parallel
prevents
seventh,
such
fifth, this heard,
the
of
the
itself;
fifth, which
remarked, their
of
however,
another
enters
par pre
in
withe
the to
voice,
deficiency
and
unpleasantness
second
rule
that,
fifth with
perfect
still be
of
the
conai{ nect
g.
^PE I 15.
I
I
As
eventh
llels,
ths
eoncems can
enter
diminished
free
imder
justifiescompletely
fifth, however,
certain the
above
conditions, expressed
which its free view,
in
the
even
entrance
since,
dominant
so
soon
chord
in the as
case
it appears
of
tho
of par^
afte
ifth, leaving
out
teps
of
outside
Compare
the
of
the
circle
following
the
of
latter
the
progression,
immidiatel^
harmonies.
both
of
connection
of
laws
its farther
account
examples. h.
a*
J
e.
J
I
^.
gizzig
"
ig:
r"
1
3C^
a:
^-
-""-
6.
ii
|zig
"s-
t
I^ however,
he stricter
instances
following
of the
I
a: ""-
in
found
frequently
are
sort
composiUons
a
style:
I
A
'9-
I -"-
J-^-
IT.
i
::3:
t
he
the
of
ression
same,
that
and
diminished
the
of
following
the
fifth is
fifth-succession
the
however,
; that,
voices
middle
doubling
the
that
assume
may
1 (the/,) requires
double
a
because justified,
thereby
progression
be called
not
could
pr^
it lies i
pore^
18.
because
artly
he
above
16.
n many
c,
do
cases
theorists
any
of are
many
duration
ufficient
also, so
them
of
them
of
the
voice
upper
is wanting,
progression
beoatibe
partly
;
instance!
although
heard. such
why
based
it is not the
those at
; which,
upon be
to
fifths
parallel as
faultless
are
same,
in the
prominently
double
unpleasant as
fifths), and
covered
ie, upon
be
to
sound
not
too
necessary
clear,
recognize
since
dmitted,
the often
it becomes
Hereby
forward
come
condition No.
as
uch
they
other
denied,
arise
spoken
false that
of
rate,
any
from
be
cannot
a
(for exam^ position
open
very
reason
unconditionally
voice-progressions, with
noti^
passing
for which
above,
their
of
unpleasantness
as
operation
and
becomes
per
there
would
eptibl^ It is not
e
much
f
the
the
place
to say
augmented
ndividual
cases
on
here,
treat ;
points
many chord
will
to
of
bring
the us
at greater as
length
for example,
sixth back
and to
of
these
concerning
fifth, which
this
point
relations, the
would in
and
progressiop here
connection
fift
too
far
us
carry with
?f the
our
practical
If the
r,
sense
more
with
yet the
f
faulty
ctave
representation
knowledge,
advanced
harmonic
entire
The
foregoing
the
of
the
system,
and
exercises,
comprehension
far
thus
progression,
still be
should
and
frequent
is
mentioned,
be
long
not
the
to
obscure
necessary
it wiU
of
too
called
be^i^
repetitioni
wanting.
fifth
(ypen
and
progression.
They
are
orms
if, in
covered^
fifth or
2i"
e,
octave,
^m
""-
"^m fifth
inadmissible
lways
farther
e
left to
f
the
not
exercises,
Kemask.
; the
beginner and
hem,
frequently
orse
faults
more
fifths
; for
the
will be
correct
matter
cuss dismust
comprehension
for
offered
be
will
this
present, a
combinations
octaves
and
with
general,
opportunity
making
unsuit*
arise. the
of
be
subject will
lead
will
a
too
are
chord-connection follows
which
in
since,
first examples,
the
out
working
unnoticed,
principles Much
in
well,
entirely
first
insight,
do
will
octaves
the
easily
mature
since,
much
^The
overed
in
harmonic
for
covered
XVII.)
i
"
octaves.
"
fifths
of
worth
instruction,
oral
interval
second
""
remain,
parallels
(in Chapter
on
fifths and
ble
octave
and
the
voices,
g.
:^2
Open
of two
motion
parallel
avoidance
anxious
and
violated, back
us
to
leave
to
other
this point,
o much
and
with
discussed.
particularly
Eocerfdses.
bring
To
the
of
observance We
into
musically
far established,
thus
rules
for this purpose
select
the
connection
following
the
three will be
Bass
20
next
exercise. :
progression
1
B^
'.Qi
-jsz:. C:
the
with
2.
1.
.^^
triads,
primary
IV
4.
8. 8*
251 is:
Rku
AUK.
long
as
The
^These, our
manner
and
"
the
well
point
under
of
will yet
as
all subsequent
exercises
practical
situation
be added,
as
consideration
the
give
251
ro:
upper us
will
proceed.
makes
three
occasion
exercises, They
give are
an
g^-^
indication
always
to
in what
be
continued
way
so
it necessary.
voices
of
the
for important
first
chord,
remarks.
which
are
to
We
have
be
can
bord
position
the
of
This
different.
very
o
chord
each
an
in
appears
that
other
e.
emoved,
situation the
of
situation
of the
roiooB
is
called
voices
in
the
if the
close position^
Soprano
the two
the
Position.
Open
and
neither
between
appear
the
chord.
Close
A
5, that
in Example
seen
already
other
three
upper
Tenor,
nor
if transposed
near
so
an
is
Bass
if the
even
voices,
lie
voices
octave,
somewhat
g.
e.
a.
i
:e
132.
f:
I
i
-G-
31.
i^i^N^N^ first position
The
Tenor
he
being
is the
se
of
he
same,
with
is the
which
lto
he
Tenor,
and close
position
but
Tenor
results,
e.
so
E
;
the
close
Soprano
the
o
the
in ef^ the
transpositions
position.
(also called be
can
Alto
between
these
E
;' in c,
hand,
other
all
former
the
Soprano
the
the
In
in open
appears
to
on
lower.
not
that
altered,
is given
and
octave
chord
the
or
an
if either
case
G
tones
altered,
if the
higher
octave
is placed
It is otherwise
is in "
a
chord
two
the
is indeed
situation
an
placed
Soprano
the
the
of
dispersed) position,
Soprano,
and
between
placed
that
so
the
thereby
g.
23.
?"=?=t==E^^E^^ At
etween G
he
lto
the
a,
the of the
and
In
this
ould
not
chord Alto
and
Soprano
in open
appears
Soprano of the
position
in close chord
e,
m
.a.
; by
position
is placed
bf an
a
transposition
just so octave
at c
lower
and
G
of
the
d"
At
between
/
the
Tenor. sense,
be
however, open
the
position,
following for
by
the
situation
of
transposition
the of
voices the
(No. 23) Tenor,
the
ransposition
Soprano
the
of
the
produce
would
open
real
of
position
thf
c.
hordy
""
"t*
o*
33.
g^gp^t^^ if the
Even
ot
always
he
view
Rema"k.
lose
nd
and
third
part
the
pupil,
be
always to
only
in the
the
for
first exercises,
the
use
be
cannot
in
begianing
the
later,
to
the
now
object,and
positiou. the
out
examples
then
upon
the
of
second
ning, begin-
the
difficulties, t
b
better
therefore
had
which
i
examples
In
themselves.
and
t
enough
clear
in close work
from
position, stumbles
immediate
is not
present
necessarily
fuller, still it i
appear
them
write
position
open
open
our
chord
present,
last they
of the
use
our
hetter
in which
onward,
which
and,
to
allows
will for the
we
^It 'will
position,
position
applied,
that
so
"
ercome
be
to
;
open
vaded*
The
various
ined,
the
position
longer
o
free,
so
of
the
as
to
it is regulated
ut
lready
This
20,
No.
to
com
occur
requires.
for
rules
the
leading
be
can
each
the
following
the
the
chosen
chords at
ai
pleasure,
connection
of
chords
26.
and
follow
may
that
position,
chords
of
voices
is determined,
chord
their
25
connection
xercise.
first
but
single,
appear
generally of the
according
pages
given,
not
leading
the
as
according
If
do
positions
and thus
of
the
voices
firs
the
of
:
ia^rf^
El
34. :s:
1
__Q_
I
0:
The
he
natural
above
specially,
the
eturn,
dapts
ant
mutual of
them chord,
relation
simple
from
the of
completiug of
the
resolved
to
chords we
two
itself into
does
become
This the
their
accurately
lies
which
becomes
another
chords
another,
close.
one
observe
last
one
satisfaction,
for forming
which
if
example,
however,
rest,
these
of
in
form
tonic
the
close
plain. this
of
connection
by
connection; connection, feeling of
o
chords
the
domi*
is called, if the
latte
close
triad,
The
clear
through
P
S
1
":
35.
Another
form
No.
bove,
of
by
is formed
close, which
Example
20,
"
ro:
=t
4, is called
the plagal
the
triad|
subdominant
close.
i
m
m
J:
26.
m ^\
1^
"0'.
E IV
Of
these
and
order
to
kinds
other
of
cannot
we
close,
more
speak
length,
at
nntiJ
ater.
In
e
Bass
if the
curs
to
the
Note."
note
other
The
All one
the
a
at
to
degree
one
of
the
triads
the
nexty
he
are
and
chords F
which
G),
"
V-IV,
it will
in various
remaining
but
key,
of
chords
called,
situated
as
to
elsewhere
by
skips,
I"egree8
Remaining
the
are
distinction
in similar
oonnectioii,
yiz., from
one
degree
to
degrees
of
not
indicate
will
upon
the
a
of scale it
so
the
will, to
be
decisively
sure, as,
belong
for example,
V-I. distinguish
from
them
the
primary
triads,
seventh
degrees
TRIADS.
third,
second,
sixth,
and
I nVu
The
riadsy
triads since
of
their
the
second,
thirds
ti
Scale.
Mc0or
scale. 27.
U
^Ed.
the
same
here,
is used in
SECONDARY
They
IV-V
successions
of 24,
"
of
combination
These
to
distance.
greater
triads
degrees
by
expression
Triads
and
the
write
succession
(as in Example
degrees,
by
the
keys.
The
from
in writing
expert
progresses
purpose
and
sitions
become
are
III
third, minor
VI
and and
sixth their
vno
degrees,
appear
fifthsperfect.
as
mtnor
of
because
this
it
third,
minor
We
for in
anner
All
triads
the
the
which the
of
degree
the
of
G.
can
scale
the
upon
triad,
theorist,
major
for
sign,
diminished
the
of
writing
fo
TRIAD.
distinguishing
designation
case
fifth;
the
easy
the
the
of
an
as
select
diminished
a
contains
DIMINISHED
hich,
has
Weber,
be
now
0,
a
add
a
small
it is situated,
which
we
triad)
minor
as
t
vu^,
above
introduced. thus
exhibited
:
""if^i^ IV
in
Rkitabk.
The
"
ombinations
F, D,
long
as
Hereby
ach
an
not
to
careful
long
As
no
the
VI
to
not
C
as
various
made
G
of
into
key,
ruling
degrees
major,
at thei
chords,
insight
is the
the
of
these
of
renders
major
be
will
the
chords,
keys.
The
triad
major
be
should
which
of F
the
this
major,
harmooio triads hey d
o
of
minor,
C
of
can
noticed
particuwly be
:
I
^m^m
29.
conceive
independent.
as
of
yvfi
which
chords
mention
appear
various
V
misunderstanding
than
else
ambiguity
belong
can
very
difficult.
do
keys
these
a
to it, and
belonging
arises
triad
triads,
nothing
are
etc.,
be
must
more
much
and
ajor,
beginner
all tonic
as
ppearance,
f=t=|F
H
ues
in respect
therefore, use
of
language),
this chord, b
this
; in all other
degree
the^r"^
to
F:
I
C:
eneral
true cases,
V
IV
G:
0
major
only
in
however,
is spoken
first
the
of
(ezpresfdng if the
case,
G
the key
major
the
m
triad
oeca
it is incorrect
Application.
In
the
found
hich
are
In
the
bring
will, can
first
onsecutive
ontrary
before,
new
Bass
The
of these
connection
hose
o
the
it is called
reason
umeral
,
beside
that,
case
out
the
rule
however,
move
either
there
chords) ; motion,
new
no
chords,
in the
according inner
will
is at
appear
by
last the
connection
a
rule of
well
present
or
be
by
aUu
with
Several
things
(like tones
in two
necessary.
with
as
it.
degrees.*
connecting
progression mentioned the
themselves
among
in connection
skijffs
always
to
as
chords.
tones
of
the
above,
voices
must
(page 26), in
be
i
order
The
a.
Bass
by skips.
progresses
NB.
b.
a.
i^p^}
laun
i^^^m
0
3"
i
in this
een
treated, tones
this
In
Example
the
there
30,
to
the
Tenor
the
hereby
o.
31
chords
is
and
if, in the
a
an
is present, as
conceived
same
so
voice.
D
doubled
becomes
of the
of
the
through
the
tones
i
Soprano
lower
as
apparent,
following
the
connection
the
octave
covered
by
improved
since
formed
voices
unpleasant
local
the
the
the
of
progression
case,
degrees,
all other in
hare
exceptions.
is certainly
immediately
connection
cases,
degree
second
from
remain
contains
last
connection
easily be
can
always
found
which
the
beginning
in many
rule, which
Bass,
inner
first chord
NB.,
above
Even the
two
from
Bass
treated
however,
are,
at
and
rogression.
ails, still
be
can
same
in the
skips
to the
rule
ccording
the
example,
common
To
he
"C.
VI
As
etween
I
-"-"
II
"
u
hat
-"-
IV
11
"i=
281
^^mi
-G-"-
in
octave,
Example
:
^P
1
31. la:
9: Rev
nce
ABE.
"
^The
this could
t is ^Q
The
however,
reason,
also
be
fundamental,
the
the
unpleasantness that
otioeable
the
upper
case
with
tone
of
why
which
the voice
if it is contained
this tone
exactly
any gives
covered
g
tone
at
to
the
octave
outer
whole
voices,
i^^^^
as
upon
double,
as
the
fact that
its determination.
chord
mentioned, a
b.
32.
whole
be conceived
is founded
pleasure,
progresses
in the
should
step,
lies in the and
in Example
stance, circum-
is yet 32
at
morf
a"
By
the be
n
improved here
lthough
See
the
ich
"
^In
leading
or
mprovement
vered
The
he
the
a
Example
other
fifth in No.
82
c^
farther
of
P
for
a
from
a
:fe
the
the
of
voieet
Example
in
motion
Soprano
i
e,
-Ct.
speak
and
Cf
Tenor
treatment
of is
No.
avoided,
firmuB^
eantus
of The
unavoidable.
stand-point. at
be
can
a
faults.
absolute
of
much
composition,
follows
step,
not
control,
theoretical
Concerning
the
34.
of
spoken
octaves
covered half
our
the
explanation
the
progresses
voice
into
in
do
we
above,
given
important presented
a
contrary
itself between
for example,
only
unpleasantness
upper
forward
ia entirely
grounds
leading
the
34).
brought
voices
b,
at
the
fifth shows
circumstances,
is here
by
manner,
covered
cases
the
of
on
in like
on
other
under
tive,
also
Eemark
Remabk. the
;
Bass
the
of
motion
contrary
ceases
at
onoe
i
g.
^^iS
33. 's::
ii
"G--
1l. Here
the
motion
contrary
NB.
The
I
Bass
hy degrees*
progresses
should
always
be
applied,
e,
g.
hett^:
1.
4.
9!=^z:g=:jzrtfzjz=gij" onjzigzz^^^ II
^ g5=^
NE.
hetter:
hetter:
:^
12?:
-"-
jSL
m
-"-
I
-G-
2.
i^^^^l
"4'-^
-"-
UI
U
-"-
IV
IV
I
I
Memarks
In
Bimilar
to
in open
appear
The
If
leading these
the
of
third
the
of
e,
second
is
unpleasantness
position,
voices
fifths
covered
because
more
subsequen
in ordef
chord,
noticeable
if the
g.
they
b
at
is to be
in the
occur
preferred.
are
be
2, the
34,
the
Concerning
B
the
iiUer discussion
able, allow-
^-^jo.
doubliug
general,
the
of
second
treatment
will be
the
of
in
since
applied,
moru
s
I
ii^ NB.
are
less perceptible.
36.
At
they
voices,
middle
11
xample
third
of
the
of
the
is to
chord), tone,
be
to Ife Worked
seventh
is called
with
always
degree
(i
avoided.
which
in connection
given
the
of
is not
chord
second
doubling
this
Exercises
leading
following
the
tone,
exercises
a "
Out,
1.
2.
IliEftEfeS
^-".
sr:
"jr
.
-G-
-"-
8. :SL
isBfE
n
the
1, and
NB.
at
used
35.
o
S?
Their
fifths.
covered
double
to
that
as
such
voices
it is better
places,
avoid
chords
7,
of
all progressions
Chord-connections.
these
on
^3$-2EElg
I -d-
NB.
4.
nil"
5.
-f2-
fS-l
-"-
"""
^
T-"-
jgg^fi
-fS-
The
fourth
The
progression
a
regular,
exercise of
consequent
gives the
occasion
Bass manner.
takes
for
a
few here
place
Such
a
T^^^
t
remarks. in the first four
regular
harmonic
measureS|
or
melo
lie
This
consequent
eading
the
of
The
remaining
treatment
down
laid
ection
occasions
like
a
also
rcgalai
voices. this
of
Bass,
the
of
progression
example,
by
above,
to
according tones,
sustained
e,
chord-con*
of
principles
g..
4-
I
^
S
fi"
"
"
B.-
-fi"
38.
"0. ""-
B
2iz=?stzx:
ould
not
ather
follow
in
into
rought
a
such
the
the
hereby
the
of
admit
same
attainment
that
position
which
tone
connecting
the
manner,
D,
this
of
chord
that
does
end
not
the
of
second
in the
remain
must
progression
first
the
of
the
;
measure
same
i
measure
occupied^ voice.
NB.
3
T
I
a
i5
i
g"
-g=--g"
i^: ^^
39. ""-
2Z
"3
-^
7-T9
t=::
"
i
3i?i:
^
:c VI
u
In
first
the
of
poken
uter
on
example,
be
the
viio
the
sequence, if they
allowable,
covered
are
octaves
found
not
i
voices.
In
third
the
far
hus
measure
have
we
of
not
It rests than
the
upon
the
hich The
natural
onceived, upper
kind
of
found
either
progression
we
meet
a
with
chord,
which
of
both tone
by
the the
tones
of
the
only
it plainly the
diminished
alone
becomes
indicates
each
other
over
against
plain
through
by
progression,
fifth. in
can
dependent
more
a
diminished
intervals
approach
is
scale, and
major
dissonance,
progresses
which
Triad*
far, since
thus
progression
lower
or
degree
is effected
that
4,
Diminished
seventh
triads
indication
No.
Exercise
used.
The
he
of
likewise
will
above
account
in
a
the
general
degree, other,
actual
be
(a), or
(", c)
chord-con"
ection. h.
a.
"g
V.
e.
e,
^
'jGT.
s
JnverftioiK
The
following
third
irst degree
Since,
efore
(C)
the
to
according
18,
(page
fundamental
tone
dominant
41.
the in
UBLED
Just
the
following
ext
This
V
to
if the
riad,
fifth in the
triad
2, operates
111
it stands
lies in the
melodic
half- step
before
as
is noticeable
leading more
in the
b and
than
satisfyingly,
not
if the
effected,
fundamental
the the
case
tone
in
a
as
of
dominant
the
of
voice,
upper
leading
of the
character
Example
c*
'
""
A.
in
particularly
is contained
tone
be
can
upwards
step
it is
distinctly,
tone.
this
progression
as
This
scale.
half
one
contains
chord
inasmuch
he
c
is called
rests,
as
very out of itself comes harmonic four-voiced movement.
simply
tendency
one,
triad, and
tone
leading
its progression
so
triad
40
eSi^J
viio
Since
See
order.
TONE.
in the
third
in inverted
diminished
the
degree.
third
the
f
as
again
the
to inversion
from
results
diminished
the
LEADING
It is found
in respect
fourth
appear
also
triad of
the
fifth.
the
intervals
augmented
which
upon
of
the
of
19,)an must
(c?),exhibits
triad
omission
relations
fifth, its progression
The
by
incomplete,
as
explained,
dimiijished
the
e*
e"
"t"
2.
This
inclination
Most
intolerable
pper
voice
(at e) In
the
of
the
n
to
are
the
39, third tone,
sequence
position
in many
or
page
formation 32,
in such
cases,
the
on
Bass
contrary
the
contained
in
the
the
more
of
of
progression
the
(the authentic
is led in
example,
the
are
in
skips
contrary a
the
as
at
d,
in the
skips
middle
voices
motion.
doubling
rule.
above
voices,
middle
chord-connections,
contrary,
Both
which
and took
place no
allowed
o
progression on
account
alteration
chord.
Extended
close
less in the
is found
measure,
to
Concerning
The
itself
shows
(at c), whereas, be used, if the
Example
leading
upwards
through
close),shows
Formation
the
chord
itself in
of of a
the
still
the
Close*
dominant, more
noticed
definite
maiX'
o
As
the
natural
a
he
two
the
renders
ominant,
formation
the
which
in which
the
in
latter
the
of
the
the so
tonic in
to
triad,
e.
the
triad,
these
examp
the
triad
chord
of
through
relation tonic
the
to
stands
same
to
close,
it is noticeable,
of
stands
dominant
the
of
chord
preparation
degree,
o
the
g,
4"
I
'ST.
-"
"
J-
S^i
"Cf
"t43.
is^i^i Besides
"^-
u
of the
triad
the
g
-"-'
n
degree,
second
for this formation
lso adapted
of the
triad
the e,
close,
i
the sub-dominant
of
g,
X
i^^j^f^ 44. :5iE"t "
"
P^
"
1
IV
The
form
definite
more
by
(cadences)produced
formvUm
closing
assume
ill
through
the
chord-connection, the
of
application
to be
chords
II.
CHAPTER Triads
The
The
fifth the
The
hord,
triads
primary
Primary
however,
relation, that
is,
as
in which
it becomes
renders
the
ihe
upon
find also
we
dominant the
through
plain
the
first fourth ^
triads
xhe primary
chromatic
triad formation of
alteration
one
to
stands of
the
tone
of
tonic
the close
the
previou
minor
necessary.
Its seventh
tone-degree^
cale, is always
distant
ally
degrees
same
found
were
scale
major
the
Triads,
scale.
shown,
ale
Upon
degrees.
minor
the
of
Scale*
Minor
the
of
a.
i^
this
later.
hown
f
to
adapted
still farther
second
of the
relation
raised
a
half-step,
a
whole so
to
according
which,
step
that
it
from
the
acquires
the
signature
eighth the
degree,
o'laracter
of
the
minor
is chromati-
of
a
leading
"-9
i
"7^"i^"^zzo"^-
45.
fr^^g" g=g By
this
like that
xactly
formation
the
means
in
i
thus
major,
A
dominant
the
of
A
minor.
mc0or.
A
of
comparison
V
A:
V
:
in
triad
dominant
become!
" "^a:
The
minor,
:
46.
briefly expressed
in
triad
the
form
O
and
major
of
close
both
of
O
major.
^
is always
minor
a
thb
shows
modes
triad,
m^jor
plainly
minor.
rtzrb-
'^^m
"l"Q-
47.
m however,
That,
nse,
s often
hich
of
capable
the any
necessary
be
cannot
i
m degree
sixth
the
of
the
melodically,
conceived
of
at
all
by
alteration
chromatic
such
scale
minor
close
plagal as
is not,
elevation proves
a
in a
a
harmonic
half-step,
(see
page
as
83)
b"
at
In
A
minor.
f^iSt
".
o:
The
elation
three
IT
triads
primary
according
to
in minor
previous
49.
i!
can
be thus
explanation
rsrrns
:
exhilited
in their natora
The
ill
be
therefore
it forms
as
scale,
mioor
following
the
basis
the
for
formabion
the
of
harmoniei
: 1
1
1
1^
7
2
:^fe:^!
50
.m Reicabk.^A11
forms
other
the
of
minor
as
scale, such
:
lfe=te 51
"P
descending
:
fed^ 53
epend
ram
the
to the
sixth
have
forms
influence
no
armonic
foundation,
ollowing
examples
degree,
seventh
however, show
do
-which
conditions,
melodic
upon
These
P
"
found
has
a
reflex
the
allow
step
of
an
augmented
second
60.
harmonic
the
upon
not
in No.
formation
influence
the
upon
in
itself considered scale
minor
; the
itself
as
the
:
I^^^^^^^s^ 53.
"c.
J.I
k
9i3i S:^ The
last B-^
econd
to
not
hrough
lready
b.
A,
B
that
destroy
the
minor
Triads
as
of the
character
through
scale,
the
(in
minor
the Remaining
in the
the
establishment
following
54.
form
:
^z=
of
the
shall
part
passage, first
third,
the
exhibits we
component
SECONDARY
After
even
scale
in chord-connections
ascending
of
-^#-
descending
necessary
secured
perfectly
The
was
in the
while,
the
in future,
b, which
tself thereby,
rder
in which
case,
iJE m
-"-
t
which
of
carefully the
of
step
example),
this
augmented
avoid,
A^,
chord, is done
an
very
explains
however,
perceptibly
(minor character)
Eb.
Degrees
of
the Minor
Scale.
TRIADS.
the
minor
scale,
the
secondary
triads
appear
i
The
degree
second
egree
the
of
the
pon
The
degree
third
It contains
The
degree.
seventh
a
third
chords
ther
armony
the
of
forced
to
this
prove
the
of
a
found
is
triad.
m"aior
triad. is therefore
connection
it seldom
the
of
called
to
chord
following
The
with
fundamental
as
appear
scale.
minor
this
of
examples
:
h"
a,
seventh
TRIAD.
allows
degree
the triad
fifth, and
augmented
character
key,
same
the third
of
serve
ay
or
constrained
the
of
AUGMENTED
THE
The
an
here
forms
degree
before
as
diminished
a
form
new
and
triad,
manner
sixth
a
exhibits
major
like
; in
scale
major
diminished
a
gives
d*
o*
f"
""
5. 0
6
^"-iSfzi^z:\zzis^z:^zJi^ IlO
Of
these
those
examples,
introduction
The
c
under
this
of
V
IV
""
best
will be
itself to be
shows
chord
e
and
VI
TIlO
for
adapted
use.
difficult stilL
more
d"9
C"
6. 6
6
6
ii=^p^^g^g^^EP^g I
Its introduction is, exists
hat
ng
ell
of
"
the
imply
as
ively
wiih
Most
ther
[triad
A^hich
ltered
already
major
of
as
of
the
the
same
as
voice
chords,
therefore
practicable
relations,
not
and
is prepared,
fifth
augmented constituent
part
in the
of
much
harmonies^
used
the
allow
in
which
of the
the
later
will be
chord
harmony,
difficult
very
seldom
this
the
of
precede
to
the
even
connect
third when
naturally
degree, it
as
appears
and
effec
occurs.
chord-connections
degree
the] third
is
scale,
that
so
scale,
major
and
foreign
peculiarly
minor
in the
triad
other
is
in the
is somethiDg
^There
minor
of
if the
tolerable,
most
VI
(at d).
chord,
Remabk.
is
V
IV
11"
exhibited to
triad
augmented
The
minor
scale.
music,
belongs
explained
above
later
to
under
be
will
the
as
recognized
augmented the
i
occur
triad,
chromatically name
Altered
Application*
The
oices,
n
bout
ince
the
etween
sixth
and
leading
the
tone
be
an
comes
as
as
avoided
second,
augmented
view
minor
scale
tones,
th which
differentharmonies,
to
e.
g
h.
a.
k:
I
sai
into
between
if both
unmelodious,
belong
the
descending,
as
was
what
in
th
of
particularl
distinctly
very
well
and
minor,
occurring
second,
degrees,
here,
in
chords
I leading
an
application
fundamental
seventh
is to
step of
have
augmented
and
sixth,
the
ontain
an
of
step
the
eventh
of
progression
harmonies
of
will also
the
of
connection the
connection
developed,
already
the
the
of
principles
^^m
e"-^^r
57.
3L^^g4^jigE{^ VI
in the
Hence,
ixth
degrees,
pwards,
oubled,
often
the
e.
triad
the
of
leading
of the
progression
whereby,
connection
recurring
in
VI
the
of
the
of
chords
fifth and
the
will be necessarily
tone
degree
sixth
the
always
third
appear
g.
M:
^i^i^^bi -fe-
^^^^m
jSiQ.
".
"C.
ii-
\^m
-fl"
""
Thus,
iven
xample
it would
not
67
No.
under
VI
VI
VI
6,
be
to
possible
unless
we
use
make
of
i
.Ol.
a
a
s
VI
VI
in
exhibit
m
-"
JQ"
correct
form
the
tone,
mediating
example
such
as,
fo
:
I
"
eg-
-G
S
Q"
59.
ii RsMARK.^The
e
he
well, more,
racf^re
practice
however, as
is and
we
to
must
should
deviates,
not
be
in certain
ourselves
accustom
overlook only
a
i
."2-
well
the
to
and the
especial leading
fact, that
founded
every
exception^
of
cases,
from
the
voices
deviation "whereas
this rule. above
from the
It wil
and
shown,
the rules
observance
in
th
of
th*
irp
Exercises
Triads
the
connecting
1.
Scaler
2.
m
IS-
0
^
.^m
-"-p.
4.
3.
%
3
5S
"3
is:
-"p-
:^=3i:
\
-"-
i^
X=X
s-
6.
6.
6S i:=5:
Remarks
n the
third
measure
This
ften
in minor,
The
ass
triad
is,
a
as
the
contains
by 3, 5, 8,
raising
of
not
in the
triad,
tone
in the
to
always
dominant
leading
spoken
of
occurs
the
very
(page 40).
of,
reasons
example,,
third
the
which
thorough-bass
especial
unless
in full, by
refers
for
figure^ as,
a
without
the
marked
fundamental,
% or
or
third
rule,
note
if the
notation, exist
for
indicating
5
^
3
One
ises.
as
is the
Exercises.
first exercise,
the
of
raising
Bass
the
of
^
tliese
on
a
over
sign
ass.
^^^E
"6K-
-"-
chromatic
1
42-
ja.
A
t
Minor
the
of
Here
been
s raised, The
for indicating
reason
introduction
the
attempted,
figure
ts position.
3
or
See,
5 in
the
of
the
seventh
of
this, the
indicate
to
degree some
third third
the
necessary
first chord to
regard
was
in
found triad
the
it
forms the
over
6, is
of
whereby
it likewise
since
it by
of the
of
to
remarks
the
and
degree that
minor
examples^ the
sixth
exer*
in minof
fifth
the scale.
indicates
next
exercises,
fundamental
features
page 50). The
itherto
working
out
developed.
an
of
We
exercise
select
will
the
confirm
for this purpose
the
first exercise.
NB.
61.
The
first principle
of
the
connection
of
chords
(by
connection
of
tones
Alto,
hi the
Becond
from
In
F
the
fault
this
from
progress
Tenor
the fanUy
makes
step
an
of
aixgrnented
G||.
avoid
Alto
(at NB.),
measure
to
to
order
io let the
while
third
from
skips
(accordingto E, and
F to
D
to
lead
to
in the
B,
44), it
page
will be from
Soprano
the
following
necessary
B
to
6^
*
manner
69.
(a
connection the
where
he
retains
tones
the
B
to
E,
harmony
following
has
which
of
F
from
Alto
the
nd
chords,
connection
Soprano
G^, the
of
and
been
already
does
not
the
Tenor
take
whereby
the
appear
in open
in the
place from
goes close
in
explained
D
81
same
voice),or,
downward
to
is forsaken,
position
No.
and
the
this
:
position
63.
Farther
eference
cale
remarks, to
render
Before
ollowing
Jlajor
the
of
chords
are
necessary,
we
to
proceed the
manner
View
of
the
the farther
the
of
to
cases
the
of
of
degrees
sixth
the voices of
be left to practical triads,
discovered
Major
leading
the
fifth and
use
hitherto
Triads
all
fourth,
in especial
chords
in
difficulties
the
which
we
the
will exhibit,
Minor
ScaleSm
Major.
p
"*"
%-
gl
"
n
a
111
flZZZ.?!
"
"-
-ix
V
IV
VI
vn"
Minor,
I
=it
:^=!fi:i5^i= I
nO
III'
V
IT
in
triads
are
I
r^^
EI5
found
Major:
VI
thO
in
minor
guidance.
:
and
i
Minott
in the
HARMOKT.
OF
MANUAL
Major
m
Minor
"fi
?^::^
:S=B:
f n
Major
in Minor
:
in
The
The
not as
Chord
of
Minor:
to
that
in all previous
the fundamental which
Inversions
the Sixths
the Chord
the
Hereby
chord.
Triads.
of the
indeed
Bass
the Sixth
of
in which
of them
use
examples;
are
III.
of the triads, and
appplication
limited
chords,
iio
triad
CHAPTER
The
:
mi vnO
Augmented
1
IT
n
ni
^
triads
Diminished
in Minor:
:
:sz
m
triads
47
the can
of
and
Fourth. chords', if
all fundamental
lies in the Bassj
fundamental
the third
also receive
arise transformations
of
or
fifth of
the fundamental
called INVERSIONS
of the chord. RjSMARK.
interyttl
It ehould
"
here
are
"vroicesinto
close
be well of, and
spoken
and
open
that only
remarked, that
position, and
before
the
to various
trantpositions
of the
Bass
transpositions
mentioned intervals, by
no
means
to anotli!Br
of the other
essentially alter
the chord,*
OF
Two
of the inversions
a.
If
THE
the
Bass
are
receives
the triad
possible with the third
of
the triady
:
there arises the
SIXTH.
Ihmdamental
66.
p
chord,
Chjord
of the aimth.
s
*
Third
ef
the
fimdamewtaZ
chord.
CH0X9
b.
F
If
THB
Bass
the
SIXTH
the
receives
the
fifth of
chord
aixth
^
Fifih
the
fourth,
is indicated
sixth
by
e.
;
^
fimdamental
ihs
of
of
JburffL
and
===g
fall
66.
ixth and
the
arises
Chord
(^ the
chord,
chord
there
FOURTH*
AND
Fundamental
The
triad,
by
6
chord.
Bass
the
over
of the
that
note,
g. 6 4
"!^E^^^g^B
67.
COO
Os
The
letter
before,
s
the
xample
nto
in future
shall
67,
only
consideration,
Rehare.
ourth
ot
lie
ormed
chords^
erived
chords.
Every
not,
however,
third
but
triad
only
can
the
not
chorda Bass
^r"^
the
upon
be
tone
and,
be
can
i
seen
taken
Bass.
E
degree,
into
in such
inversions.
another
the
of
notes
brought
chords
appear
the the
tone,
can
as
whereby,
fundamental
casual
of
C, and
fifth, but
or
the
fundamental
the
degree,
the
of
tone
67, is always
the
upon
situation
fundamental
the
"
^As in Example
for indicating
indicate
the
I
I
sorve
to
numeral
I
and
and
of
G,
the
chord
so
in fact, these
since,
by
position
the
sixth
Bass,
the
nxih
and
itself will
are
no
netely
therefore
and
Application^
By
the
use
harmony
he
(that is,
ixth
the
of
That
his
the
so,
voices
above
the
tone,
may
it needs
is
be
rules
be
also
better to
doubling
it,
or
merely
conditioned
if
thereby
remarked to
be only
the take
if it lies
even
yet
of
third),can
original
requires
thereby
noticed
in
after
mentioned,
by
not
chords,
but
movement,
the
and
leading
doubling,
Just
hree
voices
the
four-voiced
the
chords
riginal
becomes
25), it will
(page
in
ixth,
to
the
of
variety,
Bass,
the
of
According triad
more
receive
articularly
he
inversions
the
of
the
the
does
only
movement
the
of
voices,
o
and
flowing.
more
for
leading
the
doubling
the
in the
case
of
double
the
Bass
tone
the
if
the
Bass,
what
was
said the
leading
of
chord
be on
of
o
of
the
of
the
of
the
leading avoided.
excluded page
position the
be
can
is to
that
chord
the natural
faults
certain
interval
an
fundamental in the
only
place
of
from
39. the
voio"3S, and
upper
aside
The
chord
of
the sixth
therefore
can
in the
occur
following
forms
:
jQ.
i
w
:2r
1122:
-"-
-"9-
I^Fa
6".
""
The
the
use
chord
tone,
chord
We
and
will
requires
original
in the
appear
is
fourth
and
it oftenest
meet
fifth of the
the
^^P^t
the sixth
of
q/" if)^"sirc^A,
later.
the
EEg=a
the
of
cAorc?
Bass
more
certain
conditions
in
formations
the
is best
chord,
following
and
which
v""
o
mentione
The
close.
for doublivg,
adapted
similar
shall
of the
forms
hmt
than
rare
and
:
i^ei^e^^UME 69.
"c. 'jq:
I
.GL
In
the
connection
are
rules
these
judged
of
two
or
image
the
to
three
pieces
of
in relation
given
a
the
chords, of
whole,
likewise
we
;
farther
no
others,
with
already
in small
chords
still contain
better
O.
derived
chords
those
of
combination
11^
.a.
these
of
beyond
necessary
mechanical
f
S=""
^:"
music,
which,
the
mere
application
however
individual
whereby
the
omit
show
and
mechanical
cases
cant, insignifican
be
whole.
Exercises. 1.
6
6
^^EJ^ 6
3^3
n
ist
-SL
8.
6 r~
"-
"
4.
3
^fe
t
6
6
6
:-^=zsr~:
r
6
6
-"-
.Q.
6 4
6
'^-
:^
"
-"
iizpzz: t: 6 4
6
3
3
-G-
"fS-
2.
'^^.
6 4
6
t
3
6
6
a=i-
6 43
6
1
^5 -"g"
g^ 75*"
6.
^ 6
6
6
6
6
6.
i
""-
-"-
^ 6
6
1
6
6
i
i
b
m.
"6h
1125:
X^
-g-
a
6
d-
6
6
3
6
6
-6^
^
^^
1=3:
-"-
:3t
6 6
jBT
10.
6
6
41
3=t
IS.
-S
^
^s'rr
ft
fS-
"
i^;
i
6
u.
4
4_i
?E
isI:
""-
JRemarks
indication
The
first
the
the
eceive
The
Bass
It
triad
occurs
one,
oubling The
of
the
undamental
In
of
progression
eading
the
Bass.
second
If
of
figure
no
Soprano
the
third
the
leading
of
the
as
exercise
It may
situation.
the
diminished
here
because
The
natural
cases
usual
m
ri.
of
progression
z=i=d:
^:'%=^
best
can
of
be
chord
voices
occasions,
of
of to
called
the
mind
Bass
the
sixth
ihs
leading
the
sometimes,
also
direction
given,
the
the
is always
the
of
of
Bass
the
t=t
voices
is
as
follows
i
iz-
remaining
triad
6
6
X Tj:tz:
diminished
38.
page
progression
-"-
by
conditioned
thus
:
-"
-g^~g
a. 6
the
stands
chord
its being
(in the
triad
6
the
the
doubled,
is not
is already
position most
situation
fifth.
the
of
the
that
Example,
second
chord.
assumed,
in
this
cases,
The
doubled.
tone) is
in
tone
in most
whereas,
be
to
denote
first
of the
the
of
future,
the
appears
oftenest
diat its fundamental
measure
Bass.
the
of
octave
first
position it is
note,
diminished
ixth.
the
therewith
and
in
indications
Exercises.
these
on
fifth in the
the
of
all similar
also
ver
I
.^::^
^-
oprano,
nd
6 13
6
6
9-
"
^s
s
6
6
6
6
6 666666 6
6
6
66
*
the
in it
It is eyident
shed
fifth,
from
the
viz., the
have
ovement^
8.
We
lto
progress
the
0
to
fourth,
augmented same
in the
see,
first example
?he
similarity
p"
to
t^eith
be
; this,
* roJV/ly lies ahove following
f th\
if it has
even
fourth
and
others,
";
S
in
chord,
B
above, F
and
dimio*
m
four
-voided
two-voiced^
pag
Soprano
of the
an
the
as
to
sound,
converted
itself
examples
above
dominant
the
beginners
fundamental
the
i
induces
later, often
shown
ittiido'jmwardsy
en'^:^
this
of
necessarily,
given
the
of
G-.
and
n
not
was
as
inversion
the
that will
progression
Ts.
"
Examples,
above
to
lead
the
inversion
by
the
only
fifth, and
a
the
of
diminished
into
is necessary
show,
diminished
as
chord
aug-
in
caoe
progression
:
sort
jQ.
i
i
74. 6
6
"
ii faulty
on
Remark.
"
iminished
of the
account It may
the
and
but not eetjifth^
be
yet other
vice
here,
remarked
perfect,
versa,
e,
fifths.
parallel
be
to
are
that
parallel
allowed
fifths,
if
the
not
good.
the
of which
diminished
one
folhwt
fifth i Otepev
g.
good.
good. ""-
I
I
-fiL
a
-"f: 4 3
/5* 6
6
6
I
pz=ffl:
ompi^^e
The
riad,
also
the
Remark,
progression
if the
Bass
hord-connections
28.
page
of goes
may
m
the
takes
voices to
over
follow
a
here
tonic
the
diminished
triad.
"
mm
m
-jz:
6. 6
6
"
"-
-"-
A
pure, "
-"-^-
I
the
in
:
not
i
than
other
chord,
form
another
6
^^^m
6
few
leiUr:
not:
not: ^
^
1^
-G-
6
6
6
"^
diminished
reatment,
triad
The
Bass
ecessary
by
degrees,
one
or
or
the
I
6
i
""-
second
degree
be
doubled.
can
more
in
as
more
6
6
1 IF
"
-"
-"-
and
of
two
of
succession
6
-"-
its fundamental
since
6
U
TIlO
he
6
m
The
^^m
:^
chords
of
Exercise
the
Minor
sixth,
No.
70, in
moving
voices
in
3,
contrary
allows
a
with
othert.
another
progression
and
others,
motion
to
will
o
render
Bass,
the
"
e,
g.
^^^^^^^m r. 6
to
n,
-^"z'S
(^^
6
6
sure,
be
of
the
the
of
I
in various
Bass
is retained
;$^
5th
of the
sixth
6th
and
m
~"
however,
; best,
ways
also in the
rizd-
Exercises
Si
t:4
i
ia^
NGLE
to
as
octaves,
be
avoided
progressions
mportance
No,
m
voices,
70
consequ
$.
g
i
-s-
ko.
6
not
I
if the
remaining
t".
re
6
^^F=t
out
carried
succession
Covered
6
6
^pfEl^^B^^
of chords
series be
6
6
6
-G-
^
The
6
6
6
is not
in the in such
2d
and
It
cases.
the voices
he attached,
3d
which in
I
f
-fi?-=^
of to
6
between
measures can are
opposmoN
be
deduced
contrary to
Tenor from
to rule, the
and
BasS|
this, that
that
consequence
to
especial op
to
te
that
Remark.
by
sunderstood
ese
things,
and
be
been
to
avoid
sul Drdi-
not
t
decision
m
was
that
error,
h
easily
principle
fuUy
judgment
a
can
above
the
of
possible
a
by
matured
rienc expe-
the
A
of
levation
owever,
a
will
they
the
chords
of
interval
the
70,
No.
of
find
their
the
and
sixth the
a
set
of
later
chromatic
; instead
{e.g,, 6Jt or
in
a
connection
6tJ,
of
which,
5tl.) the
with
was
in the
example,
0), if
:
necessary
figure
fourth
and
(for 6
the
in minor.
often
sixth
is used,
through
the
explanation
the
sig^
have
them
of
very
occurring
becomes
after
Soipe
Ed.]
figure
stroke
half-step
a
t| is often
Jt or
sign
in general
called
are
"
chromatic
through
stroke
8, 9, 10,
Signaturen.
as
Notation.
Thorough-Bass
the
Thorough-Bass
the
works
explained,
48.
xercises
hich
German
of
page
igures
to
only
of
of
signs
and
notation
iven,
down
laying
order
down
laid
principle
the
belongs
Signs
the
[in
atures^
he
he
will always
possihle,
practice.
numhers
lready
the
in
here,
added instance,
last
that
however,
beginner;
Concerning
The
as
perfect
ignored,
be
to
the
in the
as
whole.
it may
and
evaded,
the
of
It is not
"
he
it must
etails, although
Other chords
concern.
ormation
Close
tlie
of
through
Chord
tlie
of
Sixth
the
and
Fourth.
In
the
Exercises
he
formation
uch
more
and
ixth
of
the
close
definite fourth
decidedly
of
the
70
No.
of
see,
previously
We
shape. the
we
coniing
inversion
the
mentioned,
discover,
triad,
tonic
through
namely,
before
extended that
the
the
of
put
and the
dominant
chord
triad, into of
a
the
cates triad, indi-
close.
i:
pzzzg;=g: 6 4
79.
Iff
1
-fflL
O:
The
chord
f the fourth
"0.
of or
the
sixth
second
and
degree.
I
fourth
is frequently
preceded
by
the
triad
MANUAL
64 decidedly
As
close, having
justso
weak
proper
use
now
OF
the
as
HARMONY.
fourth indicates ^c of the sixth and influence in the modulation into foreign keys,
chord
also a decided is the effect of its entrance
is
subjectto
certain
under
conditions,
The from
harmonies
of the seventh
the addition from
seventh
of
the
only
ievenths
excellent
result forms a [third]
triad, which
of triads, but also the harmonies of the seventh.
Properties
General
in connection
hand,
closer and
They
the triads.
upon
kinds
various
of the
chords of the seventh triads, but indicate definitely
the other
founded
to the fifth of the
The
only
are
( Vierklange).
p=f =i^^i^S
"
will afford manifold
The
Seventh
the fundamentaL
81.
Not
third
a
that it
so
IT. the
of
relations,
will be treated of later
which
CHAPTER Harmonies
other
more
with
they
a
triads,
the relations
connection
of chords
to
of the chords
and
for
of the
finished.
of this quality furnish
means
o/
alone, but
never
or
complete
afford anything
the most
as
they
that
so
kinds
Seventh.
of the
independent
progression,
will
the
so
not
render intimate, and by for
means
are
Chords
yarioos
each
other
in particular
leading
the
On
of the
voices. The
The
Dominant
chord
of the
Chord
seventh
of the
Seventh
which
is most
in
Major
important,
and
and
occurs
Minor,
ofteneiE
is the DOMINANT
CHORD
SEVENTH.
THE
OF
chord of the seventh. is formed dominant the fifth degree, and triad, upon alike in major and minor, that is, from the major triad and mimof
also called primary It rests, like the xactly
eventh*
dz 82. C:
V
V", 7
o:
V
V^
7
In
n
fundamental
the
our
by
indicated
notation,
of
method
by
it is marked
position
Y
7
a
Bass
the
oyer
note,
and
7 7
t
^
i^
83
.
V.
0:
The
in which
relation
riad,
has
hown
before,
hrough
become
the
The
the
following
dominant
the
of
close
of
will the
of
chords
to
stands formation
the
through
chord
combination
dominant
the
of
The
33).
(see page
use
triad
principally
clear
V.
G:
come
out
of
the
tonio
the
close
more
still
clearl;'
seventh.
formation
the
show
will
of
the
:
lose
84.
Rkicabk.
"
; in both
t incomplete from
ppear
The
^It 18 to be
-what
striving
esulting
union
the
ollows
in the
the
a
after
triad,
a
with
of
point
OF
hord
of
We
manner
THE
CHORD
chord seventh,
he
fundamental,
he
Bass,
regression
which
of
the
is wanting.
the
of
will
first
of
the the
the
as
OF
in
chord
The
of the eeyentb
of this will
reason
closing
essential
the
the
seventh
No.
the
84,
seventh in
or
a
the
and
(Cadence). the
with
way,
similar
of
progression
important
tonic
it is
triad,
ealled
intervals
the
of
the
of
the
its relation
to
progression
ol
observations. as
cadence
a
interval definite
of
the
regular
will appear
the
chord,
resolution
is regarded
impossible
is, by
If
progression.
fundamental,
:
h.
a.
JQ-
85.
chords,
especially.
seventh
contains
these
SEVENTH,
THE
of
the
furnish
to
in
CADENCE.
voices,
confined
inherent
chord
exhibited
seventh
observe
ominant The
the
follo-wiDg
is called
dominant
the
leading
the
triad
rest,
CLOSING
For
triad
follows.
of
union
the
that
fifth of
the
cases
RESOLUTION
If
here,
remarked
m
as
the
given,
an
upward
MANUAL
66 if, as
ftyen
at
6^
a
^ fe
8^-
or
the progression
downward
third The tone
step of
ffth
and
third
of
-gf
will follow a
a
progressioB
s
,^.2^Sii
-""
of ihe fundamental by an fifth is already determined, of the seventh
of the chord
of
":^
VS:
g=;
"
the dominant
said before concerning
has been
as
a
its downward
; whereas
:
scale ; its natural
the
HARMONY.
third voice is added
affords full satisfaction
Since
OF
upward
step of
fourth
a
the progression to be
remains
of the
considered.
the leading chord of the seventh is always direction is therefore determined by what the leading tone, (page 39) ; its progression
half-step upwards,
and
b will, therefore, not
appear
so
natural
:
5.
|=-
I
JQ
^"-
'jGL
i
W. :a:
"1
87, 6, the third, is given
In the Example
the unpleasantness
becomes
^^m
of its progression
quite in
tolerable if the third is found
a
upper
This
perceptible.
middle
render
voice, which
voice,
e,
leadinj
g.
b.
a.
I
to the
^^1
-"-
8",
i
^
This applied a"
downward under
If it
leading
the following does not
of the
third
(leadingtone)is
hut in ^
seldom
i 89.
J: 15?:
jSl
^:
therefore
:
conditions
lie in the upper
-g-
a
middle
pracUcabU,
voice^
e,
g.
to
be
b"
the Baas
If
contrary
I
e.
motion,
".
a.
g.
not:
If:
90.
^^^^^E The
reason
of
fifths in the The
leading
or the
ay
most
exist
we
Example
to
these
condense
the
of
Example
as
of
the
88
b
is free.
seventh
downwards
leading
the
by
the
for
voices,
covered
While, reasons
seventh,
it to
allowing
D
the
where
shows,
the
observe
Bass.
and the
of
chord
degree
a
Alto
we
gres pro-
the
of
pra So-
E.
the
chord
find
we
remarks,
the
of
following
the
seventh,
for the
and
for
rules
closing
the
regular
i
cadence
:
The
seventh
The
fundamental
ards
the
of
if
evident,
hf between
it is crowded
with
becomes
rule
fifth
the
upwards,
resolution
a
progresses
a
makes
skip
downwards^
degree
diatonic
of
fourth
a
while or
upwards
fifth
a
dovm
;
Just
the
so
The
fifth
Remark. was
8).
Both
a
he led by
can
said
is led
third
By
"
hat
progression
of the
fundamental
found
are
degree
degrees,
the
intervals
fifth in the
dominant
in the
seventh
tJie seventh,
diminished
the
and again
towards
third
the
while
j
downward.
or
upward
the
of
toward
upwards
of
chord
are
we
reminded
dimmished
the
triad,
o
(page
seventh.
Application.
Except
in the
s, in the
o
last
part,
is lead
If
second
of
degree
a
the
connected
articular
us,
he
the
ominant
upper
voice,
thesis), since
in
(See
page
Besides an
hirdy
while
the
employed
in
in
position
only
place,
the dominant
closes,
seldom
a
of the
chord
thus
the usage
whereby
seventh known
far
feeling
the
of
produced.
whereby seventh
the
complete
in
cases
the
close
falls upon
close
the
where
the
chord
or,
if the
incomplete,
becomes
the
of
seventh
accented
part
tonic
(cadence) the
of
the
triad
measure
must
fal
33).
this, the
interval.
the
particularly
of the
chord
here.
take
place
of
piece,
is not
close
takes
in
a
of
if it does
and,
This
formation
middle
complete
ies
f
in
progresses
This
chord
often
interval,
omission
of the
incomplete
appears however,
can
fundamental
only or
through
be
the
the
the
omission
fifth, seldom
seventh,
would
the
entirely
6.
e*
d,
rardy:
g;
"
,
"
fi^-
"
"^^^E^4^^wm^m
""
r
-""
91.
m
In
he
hf
a,
df
is allowed
which
ollowing
hich
We
fifth is
the
doubled
fundamental
one
chord,
was
not
add
the
2s:
^
remain
in the
case
following
Cf
the
stationary, tonic
closest
the
by
means
of
with
(See
the
84).
in the
interval
an
of
the
complete,
again
No.
oas6
each
connection
appear
omission
in
and
affords,
resolution.
upon
i
third,
to
triad
previous
remark
the
doubling
which
the
allows
and the
instead,
to
in
omitted,
I
:
hord
Through
mitted
the leading
of
will, in
interval
the voices cases
most
a
chord
he the
can
fifth of
^
incomplete
appear
the
fundamental
; the
chord.
Exerdsesm
1.
6
7
:?c
ifE^
a.
6 4
6
i
t
-t=?i 2.
6
!36^
6
6
7 ?"
"
-"
-"-
g--^^
""
""-
-^"
8.
6
i9'
-4SIZ.
-g
Hi
iiS^ 7
^3
6 47
^JL
"s-
-/a-.
t
-^
6 43
6
6
7
^
"
5.
6 4
6
6
is:.
(fi-
-"
1=^
:t
F=t
6
6 4
6 4
6
6
-"-
7
t
q=::f
"^E
^^
jSL
t
T
O
I
-*""
67 6.
^-^
6
6
jy
""-
^
"""
t=l:
These
exercises
require
V=t
no
farther
4"
li
^
explanation.
It
has
been
already
to
Bass
inversions
The
Like
the
that
The
triad,
the
Bass
the
Chord
the
arises,
general, have
them,
al
refer
55.)
than
other Bass
if the
be
can
Seventh*
the
of
seventh
interval
an
receives
to
opposite
in
or
V.
the
of
it,
under
(See page
tone.
of
chord
first inversion
in
altered the
a
man*
fundamentaL
the
receives
such
third
the
mental funda-
Bass,
and
of
;
The
if the
second^
The
if the
thirds
In
close
A
comparison
hose
of
original the
position
the
fifth of
of
triad,
fundamental
the
seventh
inversions
of
their
plainly
to
given
lower
the
the
voice.
thus
themselves
present
inversions
these
shows
is
lies in the
chord
chord
of
the
position
analogous
:
with
seventh|
:
6 4
i 6
6
94.
^i"")
Kt)
J:
;="-] -"-
1
G.
These
heir
f
figures
without
the
found
sharp
CHAPTER
r,
f
occur
from
third
the
the
that
which
signs
hromatic
nce
7, also
by
indicated
derived
intervals
'^he
The the The
designation
from
the
position
of
:
first inversion ; the
second
fourth third
their
receive
chords
:
and
the
is called
chord
of
the
the
chord
sixth,
of the fourth,
sixth and
and
third,
fifth. or
briefly, chord
third. chord
of
the sixth,
fourths,and
second,
or
briefly,
chord
the second. Their
designation
in the
Thorough-Bass
notation
is to be
seen
above,
in
It needs
efore
in
distributed
usly
that
and
the
among
triad,
the
of
is essential,
voice
here,
remembered
inversions
the
lowest
he
be
to
only
the
only
the
e,
2?:
-o-
""-
of
Bass
the
intervals
just
ns,
or
be
can
ai
o
vari
g.
* ^:
inyersi.
position
remaining
voices,
upper
in these
that
^^
"^-
I
r"5L=:ti38^
5. G-
"9
4 3
6 6
6 6
I
-9
.GL
4 3
i
^
-%^ "C.
'"^^
9-
^
IE
A'pplication.
The
that
pon
If, in its
n
the
case,
direction,
cue
lso
fundamental
the
of
in
*xi"t
to
chords
the
cither
seventh,
the
conditioned
seventh,
derived
the
of
the
and
the
tendency
case
derived
these
is founded
chord.
dissonance,
the
the
undamental
(resolution)of
progression
regular
same
(resolution), will
progression in which
chords,
again,
appear
progression
the
two
become
or
tones,
the
seconds
by
version. or:
^^t=^
""
:s:
Progression
Since
in the
ne
he
he
the
of
original
progression
of
the
place
thus
of
sixth was
which
97
resolution
the
seventh
of
chord
im^
the
Cliord
of itself
shows
fifth,
and
discussed
as
"^"^
^
-g
g)-
of
the
sixth
ii^^=[f
Sixth
likewise,
Fifth.
and
over
dissonance^
above,
:
9H.
tJie
.
chord
K
-Qg
Iffi^
against
as
the
diminished
Bass
Jlfth
(page 38),
I and
fifth
will
naturally
taktf
The
here, since
the
fifth.
the
G
upper
is, however,
This
this connection
of
the
of
fundamental,
the
of
progression
is sustained
voice
the
marking
does
given,
that
not
it forms
below
G7
voice,
cannot
foundation
the
C, of
appeal
itself into
transforms
and
for
apparent,
only
harmony,
of
before
as
Example
98
proves. That
however,
the
ut
progression
in
in mediation
ore
foundation, Remark.
eading be
of
belongs
^Deviating
"
the
^Progression
of
We
here,
ifth
find
again
its inversion,
or
99.
The
of the
are
give,
not
is to
which
othe7
be
found
laying
in
than
these
cases,
hereby
such
excluded,
their
as
a
only
freer there
Third.
and
its inversion,
and
fourth
the
diminished'
:
ES^
g
^m3/-
Fourth,
Sixth,
the
seventh
augmented
g--
follows
this chord
of
resolution
carry
chords.
beside
the
in
fandamental
would
Chord
the
harmonies,
the
the
of
the
voices,
notes
lies, beside
cases,
such
these
in
Bass.
relations
of
in
of
of
the
progressions
connection
middle
character
to
in certain
voices
inner
an
the
connection
and
which
a
or
fundamental
the
of
immediately
easons,
ust
Soprano,
the
thus
:
^"^^
91=^^1^^^^^
100
0
Giy
The
Bass,
the
original
fifth,
Progression
This
The
the
and
eventh
econd
has
chord
below ^
the
and
of
Chord
the
that
fourth
this
is
chord 2
as
of
given
dissonant
original
in
occur
only
the
ways.
Second*
the
of
the
fifths can
0
in both
progress
peculiarity,
augmented
progression
can
of
diminished
Oi^
their
intervals, inversions,
the m
below. follows
6
:
2
6
101 ^
a G^
C
"^
G^
C
7
Thus
he
the
chord
We
can
of
resolution
of
the
the. chord
of
the second
is effected
here
thiougli
sixth.
perceive
in
these
resolutions,
that
they
are
all based
upon
the
MANUAL
62
as
G7
mental
o
These
C
a
so
adences^
sort
these
The
those
as
the
everywhere
same
marking
are
above,
by
the
Progression
of
Sixth
the
of
the
form
themselves
mentioned
designated
Chord
Chord
HARMONY.
the
of
fanda*
I.
Natural
of the inant
a.
V7
or
find
we
res^^lutions will, therefore,
complete
View
for
cadence^
called
or
name,
of aU
Seventh
in
and
as
onlj
cadences^
those
imperfect
Inversions
are
called
not
perfec
cadences.
of
the
Dom*
positions,
various
Fifth.
and
02.
i
i b.
The
Chord
of
the
Sixth,
Fourth,
and
Third.
or:
CT
^az^tr^
as
I
"G'jrr
\^m
4
4
"s-
--^:g: 6
xzTfird^J 4 3
4 3
m
"^ G.
0
4 3
^m
o
Chord
The
C"
in
Exercises
the
6 6
Chords,
these
of
6 47
326
66
t
i"
103.
Use
Second.
the
of
rsi
:5=^
^
i
2.
i:3fe
3
4 3
c.
-"
6 6
6
6
6
-St
:f=t 8.
3
^
-5/
2
6 6
4 3
6
i
-S
ip
87
^
"
1
sL
X
X
6 4
7
:?s: -"-
ipz
f 4.
4 3
6
SIS
6 4
6
3
6
3
"
-"-
-51
f
6 6
3
6
I
^"
izni
-"-
"
-c"
6.
f
6
i:^^:
"-
87 %
6
^^
g-
-"-
2i 6 6
6
67
4"
^
rsi: -"-'
2S:
1^
1^=1^
f 7.
3
--"-
i^
6 6
6
1=^
^51
:?2=
^
a
67 6
1^
g-
"
4"
f 8.
6
PiiE^:
Observation.
econd,
87
:aL SSL
5.
^P3
6
fourth,
4
3f
6
3
67 4S
6
-"-
r
"
and
The
EE:
marking
fifth
8 7 in the
Examples,
denotes
next
to
that
the
last
the
seventh
measure
pf
should
tlj not
CHAPTER
Secondary
While
in the
eeded
enders
riad
same
6
tones
(as tonic
ssential
rom
chord
the
key
ase
the
of
amental
indeed
to
be
one
primary
which
i
chords
alone to
which
of
in
but
already the
tonio
the
no
relation
of
common
called
the
centre,
be
of
relation
formed
which
decided
so
means
or
primary can
seventh
the
minor,
their
seventh
3).
also the
the
of
to
in the
as
called THE
OF
by the
SEVENTH.
a
of
addition
seventh
of
the
fun-
:
In
Major:
In
IV
ni"y
Ttp*
6.
page
of
by
CHORDS
simply
22,
seventh,
and
are
triads),to
above,
the
chord
triad, renders
dominant
(See
major They
formed,
dominant
the
of
harmonies
seventh,
chord.
triads
the
of
t
requisite
point),there
central
progression
the
of
undeniable,
a.
Minor
"VTy
T
Til" Tll^iy
w
:
NB.
NB.
N Ij
"We
here
come
other
ith
e
to
as
content
subdominant
of
chord
triads
primary
are
triad
only
seyenth
the
clear.
SECONDARY
They
the
of
entirely
the
of
is
are
chords
seventh,
the
natural
(as fundamentals
remaining
efinite
the
of
the
and
dominant
this
tonic
seventh,
fact, that
triad),already
Beside
the
chords
fundamental
F,
and
to
primary
key.
manifest
time
three
Seventh.
the
of
triads,
the
df
the
^The
"
s at the
the
of
certain,
represents
Remark.
wo
key
the
of
chord
the
Harmonies
(the relation
case
dominant
he
case
key,
the
establish
,
the
in
VI.
was
chords,
already
decided
to
and
Among
these
and
that
as
be
harsh, their
above,
remarked
will, therefore, variety
very
sound
in
which,
relation
dominant
the
rare,
coloring
to
chords
for
and,
more
part
especial
secondary
of
VI
IViy
formations,
chord
clear
Hl'-y
l^rj
of
the
in
the
of the
harmonic
the
the less
because, key
fundamental
a
not
seventh,
oonnectioB
foreign,
reason,
chord
but
without
part,
this to
TnO|y
jy
is not
Their
seventh.
adapted
for impar
succession.
following
kinds
may
"n
triads
Major
v)ith
major
in
Major:
1
at
|^*
^
seventh,
0:
NB.
the
f
triads
Major
minor
with
JAfkM*:
seventh
VI-
IV
dominant
form
always
chords
seventh. in
!)"
Minor
triad
vnth
-j-^ "
:
Minor
triads
seventh.
in
Major:
triads
iti^
i"
M(dor:
Minor
m
minor
with
a:
Vliy
niiy
niy
""
Diminished
Minor:
g C:
d*
harmony.
I
minor
with
fundamental
as
x"
in
C,
used
not
w-
seventh,
major
Minor:
seventh.
;B TU0|
nOi
a:
in
Diminished
The
f"
from
ery
before
reasons
seldom
Remabk.
pplication
(which
or
to
elation This
eventh,
oves
If
that
than
other
Yiz,
by
the
concerns
accordingly
or
the
sure,
not
useless,
i
triad,
augmented
as
with
the case
or
of
to
secondary
of
toward
downward
progression
dissonance
major,
Major* ished, dimin-
minor,
always
in it
progression.
chords
the
the
a
X.
in
; it will
only) augmented
in
found
be
may
in Chapter
Seventh
tJie
of
of
dominant
the
seventh,
of the
chord
fundamental,
if the
latter
upward.
the
principal
ound, 3:
106.
be
the
of
foundation,
second,
second
downwards
fourths,
another
the
J
fifths
case
Chorits
is,
already
degree
one
is, to
minor,
the
with
press
progression
natural
again,
Secondary
fundamental
the
in
its inversion,
or
seventh
seventh.
ambiguous.
the
of
in
.*
seventh.
m"ajor
degree
developed
find this chord
^We
"
The
and
used,
with
third
the
upon
diminished
with
triad
augmented
it is found
ut
triad
il/in*f
*
intervals
of
the
chord
i
OF
MANUAL
66 for led
the
intervals,
remaining degree
one
rule is necessary
new
no
third
; the
ffth
of the
the progression
while
upward^
HARMONY.
be
can
be
will
in either
direction. fit.
i
,^j^U^^^^^^^\l
107.
m
I C:
I
-"-
IV
ni
deviation
REUARE.^The
107 bf is occasioned in the regular atcennon
by
firom this
the
f^^i
-^
iSZ
that
circumstance,
of the
third
a
^T"
in the progreBeion
rule
the
step,
whole
octave,
covered
e,
of the
third in Example
which
appeal
would
g.^
^zp"=a
108.
I^^B
^=^ was
avoided
See
thereby. however,
Whether,
succeeding
Example
in Example
as
following
the
or
chord,
85,
page
107
covered
32.
the
c^
leading
tone
should
in th*
be doubled
fifths be preferred,
:e
p 1"0.
m will depend
diBular
Natural
upon
circumstances
1
I which
ean
only be
m\
judged
of in the
application
to p"r
cases.
(Oadeneing)
Progression
Seventh a*
of
the
first
Secondary
of
the
in
Major.
~".
the
I
not:
3;
110.
^t=SL
of
degree, or:
I
Chords
\=^.=X^^
"^^
\
omission
meUh
J^/th :
the
of
=:iF-6^
I
-fiffl-
-" 5^-
--" "
p~
""
:b:zs^
tA"
(/
deffrse.
Moond
J^fth
without
-"-
mm
:
or
:
"?:
I
-fiL
":
"O"
:^:
not: -^
iip^i^
J
e,
of
the
I
-""
"-
degree:
third
2
:5a:
r^^f^^
J
T
I ~oiJb:
T~s~r
"7g"~~r
-n: not;
0:
T~"g~j
not:
"
".
: no";
VI
llliy
"l.
r~tf~r
1
of the
fburth
i:
degree
(seldom
with
this
1 ;S5S
": 32:
resdlvUon), JSL
pi go.
.J
not
^
'good: a.
jQ.
"
1 -g-
not.*
0:
IV
vn'
ir
1^
I
I
= -g-
_3.
I
":
I
-"-
5-.
^m f,o/th6
not
better:
good: i9-
$
jO.
Z^
ig
s
i
i
3:
II
I
-"-
-6f-
3E3 "r-^
JQ.
not: ni
I
=g:
I
-"-
^
3"'
3^:
.G_^
P
i
-G-
-*""
not:
Bemark.
heir
^The
"
positions
not
fifths
other
ith be
and
o the
ind,
the
the
ore
in
the
by
means
about
not
false, the
In
the
above in
others,
undamental
has
found
takes
and
harmonic
occurring
and
this
as
cases,
only
in the
ones
similar be
often
not,**
(inasmuch
in many
faults,)are, cases
as
such
judged
according
53).
in furnishing
edv4:ation
in
and
a
for all
rules
positive
inadmissible
and
Progression the
led place,
No. to as
110, the
of
this
can
respect,
really
musically
of the
cases
only
be
tin dis ear.
educated
of that
third
with
the
Chord
the
of
the
Seventh
Degree.
seventh
collection
under
been
(pages
above, Bass,
the
of
must
structure,
52
added
such
while
ones.
possible
frequently
the
i
neither
later.
especial
major,
pointy
harmonic
admissible
of complete
the
stand
are
^
are
these
produces
seventh
only
in
only
leading
the
the
as
also, which to
succeeded
yet
of
eventh
he
expressed,
this follows
oncerning
part,
refer
pure
so-called
has
theory
and
remarks
theoretical
a
before
true
most
lies
the
of
exhibited
progressions
the
voice-progressions,
from
principle
Since
octaves.
necessary
even
such
All
for the
understood
ractice,
nor
been
they
all chords
of
progressions have
forming
of
which,
good"
found
above
exhaustive,
difficulty
The
overed
o
degree.
seventh
the
progressions
of the degree^ other
chords
all
degree^
seventh that
of
is, the of
the
chords
of
analogous
progression seventh,
the
with of
the
through
ore
armony
oftener,
to
upon
a
most
(see page
triads
6.
Ck
to
the
1^
3@ Wz
the
tonic
triad.
I
i ."_.
Sr
11.
i
m
11
.Q-.
C:
The
Example
the
tonic
the
to
vnOi
viio
above
riad
It is likewise
otherwise,
by
altered
addition
if the
that,
remarked,
triad
fifths would
perfect
the
the
of
diminished
the
of
relation
I
but
seventh,
decided.
more
of the following
third
the
osition,
be
to
"II*
the
that
plainly,
is not
triad
.(2.
VIlO
shows
becomes
contrary,
ecause
seventh
6.
a.
1
the
of
progression
here
which
to
leading
a
That
-
50), viz., that
and
in
used
(sequence).
the diminished
38
only
part,
formula
certain
which
is based,
added,
is, for the
and
according
curs
8
one,
unusual
chord be
must
112
No.
the
(seeNo.
doubled,
(See
;
arise
in
appears
above
Ill
6)
a),
6.
a.
I 1=1f=^^^^E^
S
112.
m
ii
a
ound,
'It
and
in
lies
positions,
as
used,
in spite
which,
is peculiar
eventh
ther
be
must
skip
to
this
the
at
of
chord, voice
upper
b^
a
i
r
leading
that
of
octave,
covered only
that a
produces
impracticable,
if not
I
the
i
-"-
-^
Tenor
the is
very
position
effective.
it in which
of
satisfactory
still appear
is often
which
effect,
the
the
while
less clear.
"^
1
"
"OP
-"-
6 4
13. 2
m
Ml
.GL
IIexark.
"
rogression,
hord
hich,
of
the
though
the
^Whether the
charaoter
seventh,
similar
with to
reason
of
the
of
added that
of
ninth
lies,
ninth, the
is, that
this
(as
is the
seventh,
in
sevtenth
theorists
some
hasis is
the
of
this
still much
with
assert,
that
its above the
its
used
dominan
chord
with
more
comprehensive,
resolution and
Treatment
Freer
The
Various
connections
likewise,
third
o,
Where
still other
make
an
becomes
ften
Sevenths
The^;^^
goes
degree
This
all took
do
progressions by
steps,
means
sometimes
makes
in reference
freer,
e.
third
the
leading
the
which
ft.
|ii s"^
downwards,
principally
place
in thi
nsed
and
and
interfere,
not
a,
upwards
of
octaves.
of
and
Chord
the
been
already
upwards,
fifths and
independent
more
have
a
in
Fifth
and
intervals
goes
of, covered
faulty
these
the
chords.
sometimes
in avoidance
and
Third
downwards.
third
a
of
skip
of
the
these
of
progressions
revious
he
of
especially,
the
of
voices
g,
not
""
goo4^
^g"-=j^=^
-CL
114.
^^^m^^^^^m That
it, is shown
of
dmits The
leading
from
skip
ime
different
leading
deviates
from
in
out
it
than
far the
Thus
nothing harsh
The most
ecessary
the
of a
is not
good,
because
degree,
seventh whole
if the
a
progression,
of
the
Preparation
position
skip
of said
the
the of
chords
which
is that
voices
will
an
of
the
a
of
of
this subsequ
at
the
same
fundamental
itself, if
present
we
used.
the
has
seventh
been
spoken
their introduction.
entrance
in
Bass
the
called
Seventh*
the
of
is
More
if the
hitherto
of
(F-B),
steps.
only
chord-connections
sevenths
careful
voices,
three
leading
the
been
effect of
middle
fifth is possible
above
progression
has
the
contains
the
of
OOhe
f, but
f
other
b
at
to
fourth
the
the
in consequence.
still other
general,
earch
Soprano
occurs
the
in
possible
e"
at
because
ritonus^
A
also
the
of
fourth
ugmented
The
is
leading
this
of
many
secondary
introduction
of
them,
dissonances^
chords which
of
particularly
and
the
seventh^ in
consists
renderti
their
pre-
aration,
D
A
tone THE
is SAME
prepared, VOICE,
if and
it as
exists
harmonic
already tone^
in so
the that
foregoing it
can
be
chord
m
connected
onh
by
Suoli preparation
f chords
is contained
tone
a
of
e.
shown,
previously
in tlie first connectiou
already
g.
"g--
f:
*"
o-
11". T=2E
^ It
be
can
by
ared
0
the
xample
here,
said
of
C
that
the
first chord
the
preparation
in
Soprano
the
of
; likewise
the
the
Q- of
is pre*
chord
second
in
Alto
the
the
following.
The
necessity
esult
of
from
alone
harsh
the
enter unprepared], but
lection
two
of
the
of
effect
the
of of
particularly
binding
and
haracteristic
t
s
GL
their
entrance
from
the
and
if they
chords,
does
not
/r"",
struck
harmonic is
which the
without
which,
are
of
character
consecutive
sevenths,
however,
sevenths,
con-
especially would
preparation,
appear.
The
preparation
the
of
take
now
can
seventh
in
place
following-
the
nner:
"=F
^ii^^^s
^
16.
g^^gg C:
m
V
IV
I
"
"
IV
^Si^---a
"
^
~cr=^^^^
IV
n.
EgEE^E? -""
f
"9-
v^^
m I
[=js:
0:
In
all these
In
a*
vi"
VI
tone
the preparation
of
such
"| IV
is connected
which
of
preparation,
m
-""
"
n
"e.
t
TllOi
by
a
tie with
the
followi
the seventh. the
following
rules
to
are
b"
:
The
at
takes
preparation
(arsis)and
asure
!)"
the
forms
formation
the
bserved
niiy
Examples,
like tone,
i
F
IV-rvn"
in
11
^E
giz"-F=Ez=gz:i
1
least
he f
place
upon
the
unaccented
part
of
th$
must
of
as
long
duration
as
the succeeeding
seventh
/
it
can
fiol;
117.
Remark.
The
"
doctrine
he
ecause
preparation
harmony,
of
it rests
upon
be
is to
and
the
most
forms
the sewetUhe
of
of
part
and
inner
the
the
of
through
carried
essential
one
important
mofit
intimate
most
and
car"^
much
with
practiced
o
parts
connection
harmony.
f
If
here
also that
mportance as
f
he
they
are
the
of
for in
called
These
and
even
the
of
by
case
concrete occur
mostly
exeepHone^
then
can
(Page
always
by
softened
and
judged
Remark).
"
harsh,
less
th"
as
44
those
as
leading
good
remi
the
against
nothing
be intended
only
be
still again
prove
relations.
eeventhe^
minor
may
which
but
and
position
the
we
adduced,
connection,
VA
and
than
the
with
degree,
seventh
else
harmonic
be
can
practice
nothing
principle a
exceptions
second
in
exceptions
o
the
of
oices.
An
y
especial
the
his
seventh
is the
7%#
dominant
is to be
voices
does
seventh demands
ejitrance
to
the
the
seventh
essential
triad, enters
tonic
fundamental
the
notj
without
and
be
may
the presence
uure
called
to
is formed
preparation
necessary
key,
[wit
does
and
not
cases.
following
the
use
the
its relation
foreign
and
in all
preparation its farther
he
harsh
least
to
fihord, also
through
which,
Of
ree
dominant
the
of
one,
effect]the
equire
howerer,
exception,
to
he
of
remarked
sure^
the
require
yet
it
leading
o
preparation,
fundamental^
if the
harshness.
118.
The
Remark."
Nired, conform
he
passing
so-called
to the
rules
of
the
Chapter
see
sevenths,
passing
sevenths,
passing
of
which
notes,
which
degree
in
as
course, are
explained
such,
cannot
later
be
pre*
Concerning
XYIIL *
The
se,
seventh the
chord
also of
of
the
the
seventh
diminished
seventh),
major by
and
reason
minor
of
(in the last their
espeoial
Exercises* 1.
M
119
3
7
^^
2.
"^
8
0 4
6
7
m
i t
"
^
t
6 6
6
^^
6 4
6
6
7
-^ -".^"G.
6 6
6
6
6 4
7
-"-
a
:?"
^-
32:
6 6
6 6
7
IS
6
6
7
1=3:
"-
"
4-
E
^-
"
t=t
"-"s'
^-"-
Connection
7i6
The
n
former
the
or,
riad,
a
The
or
is
which
third
reparation
emain
of
the
e.
stationary,
degree
same
of the
seventh,
hereby
no
also
will
place
fourth
degree
Instead
of
the
the
follow.
alteration, serve
as
therefore
not
will
seventh
and
of
can
took
seyenth,
helotv.
degree
ffth
suffers
voices
following
the
the
first chord
the
the
of
of
seventh
of
progression
of
the
triad
the
themselves*
among
of
chords
through
always
equivalent,
the
of
the
of
Seventh
the
of
resolution
Examples,
chord
the
se
Chords
the
of
progression
bove,
only, the
in this
necessary
progress,
but
g.
1=1 ^^^s 120.
":
a
-"2"G"
-^z IV
G:
Here
he
the
third
following
The
hords
he
6
fifth
eventh
the
of
the
dominant
B,
the
chord,
forms
the
preparation
"A
seventh.
peculiarity of
of
in
seventh,
the
succeed
this the
connection
ffth
first chord
each
other,
the
been
ffth
left
In
he wanting.
will always
has
is, that
of harmony
out.
will
If
always
several
be
in
one
of
120,
Example chords
wanting
th
of
in
the
each
131.
IV
The
following
his kind
If
for
apply
ToPpf
Tl Tim
lUiy lUm
m
of
connections
Y
Urn
m
harmony
o
:
two
more
or
chords
of fifth is
the
POSITION,
ENTAL
the
follow
seventh in
Omitted
each
m
oih^
each
funba'
the
chord.
alternate
Exercises* 4 3
1.
6
6 5
6
ii^ 2-gs:
32.
2.
i^
6
:^
^^=F 4.
6 4
6
6
"^
^
5
7
iS^
7
7
7
4 3
6
6
6
6
3?:
22:
-ci-
:s=il:?
""-
6 6
6
6
m
-G-
The
rise
of
Many
the
the
secondary
A
chord
of
progression
is not
them
for
in their
Secondary
of
of
mbiguous,
orm,
1
'SL
2:
pplication
o
therefore
may
rule
"r
Chords
chords
show
themselves, as
chord-connections
cadencing the
formed
conceivable.
133.
to
the
the
as
be
to
they
above,
the
the
since
applied
degree
in steps
gives
the following
Minor*
ited lim-
more
indefinite
or
unmelodic
frst
is
minor
incapable,
were
in
Seventh
in
seventh
heavy,
progressions,
seventh
analogous
of
of
major, of the
it,
chord
can
and
others
voices.
afford
connection
Rkkakk.
cmied,
if irith
^EVen
"
as
such
the
above
combtnaivm
of
interval!,
u
progrMi*.
:
perliapg
fe^E^I 134.
ii
hardly
till tbis would
hord
the
of
The
seventh
frequently
chord
:=f:
71
6
that
proof
first degree
the
of
as
admissible
the
of
resolution
is very
nd
be
-It
g in this
have
we
a
of f
progression
in minor.
of
the
is into
degree
second
daminani
the
used.
35.
"".
7 -a.
^m^
jss: -"-
l^^^ilf
""*" not: ;
"
A
not:
nOi
progression
of
the
chord
the
of
seventh
of
third
the
is no(
degree
npossible,
ifg
^^
^
ffs
I
.
136.
ii
:a:
igs: rfsr
7"not;
IIIV
a:
t is
(See
minor.
It
be
may
The
eading
of
the
of
the
voices
be better
might
to
adapted
C
major
than
in
here, will
always
fourth in
addition, go
and
their
upward
sixth
resolution
that one
the
ffth
in
this
chord,
degrees
are
unusual,
because
inconvenient
becomes
^
^
P^i
and
good:
^9gi
y^
97. 7
m
^
I
i iiS:
^
|s
aa
degree.
elodic.
#
to
Chords),
remarked
chords
and
Altered
interval^
ugmented
VI
however,
ambiguous^
not;
I
7
the un-
f=gE3Hf=E^j^g^j^
19"
^EgEj^i^^^Si^g
The
and
forced
The
known
A
it would
of
important
an
chord,
DIMINISHED
in the
is generally
which
as
upon
the
all
of the
ambiguous.
with
the chord based
this chord
which
impossible,
degree,
the
of the
upon
is
rest
third
and
68), is
(see page
tone^
of
triad
doubtful
as
SEVENTH.
manner
in the
result
major
leading
the
THE
OF
above
in
degree
seventh
brings
this, its progression,
of
unmistakable^
of
necessarily
represented
Instead
name
this chord
of
resolution
is
progressions
above
use.
CHORD
THE
already
was
which
seventh
ths
of
sion progres-
natural
:
rests
* '^ "O"
.JQ.
I
139 -O*"'
As
led
fundamental
the
the
so
just as
of this
to,
(leadingtone),progresses
chord
half-step downwards, the
with
(No.
because
chords
other
130
the
seventh
leading
the
must
a)
it easily
of
while
third
faulty
produces
of
a
and
half
st^,
fifth
are
; especially, the
be
third :
progression
not:
a*
@
K.-
-"S^
mM
130.
m
viiOi
o:
VIlO viiOi
positions
many
attended
accurately
"
a
as
regularly
in
A a:
moves
also
seventh
however,
p-
^m^^ tf
irhereas
of
the
under
the
of
in minor
degree
seventh
most
of
frequent
their
prevents
since
of
character
Remark.
the
whereby
"
seventh to
this
the
^The
arose
natural
in
degree
find the chord
at
position
basis
with
both
a
of ninth
chords
h and
c
progression
major,
to
it in the
(major of
the
the
gives
to
of this
chord,
tonic,
minor)
seventh
has
third
as
added
degree.
well
greater
as
of to
the
it, and
freedom.
of the chord the
occasioned
hannony
dominant or
the
older
seventh. the
of the teachers
They
fundamental
seventii of
mony har-
conceived omitted
ean
he
bring
only
chord
implicity
here
forward
as
is needless
of
the
ninth
of
the
harmonic
for
reason
and
been
for
that
and to
preferred
that
offered,
view
far-fetched,
has
system
the
the
this assumption
practical
more
o
the
purposes,
excursive
explanatio"i
it
f
For
the
The
See
following
the
ddition
diminished
the
of
application
diminished
the
of
chord
in
observe
seventh,
:
the
as
seventh^
no
all, needs
of
mildest
preparation
72).
page
Exercises. 7 1.
6
6
%
9
2:".r
31.
6
-^=^-
i:t
3
(S-
sS""
6 6
7 2.
J
3
6
6
2
""
its:
3
i
i^:
fS
^
6
7
The
foregoing
nly
have
hus
far
the
object
explained,
inflexible of the
hords
oint,
which
did
ould
only
The
ass,
he
not
may
skip
an
tone,
is,
have
a
7,
could
to
already
serve
of
be
as
selection
sure,
or
learned
chords
in the
the
fundamental
o
position
present
stand
difficult,
was
means,
something
number
great
our
chorda
have
down,
the
upon
of other
the
remains
Bass the
the
and
122
tone
a
perfectly could
inversions
here
of
from
the
third
remain
the
leading
of the
is found,
seemingly,
the
there
of No.
exercise
progression
regular
manner
of
the
in
stationary,
dominant
the
everywhere
makes
131,
and
stationary, in
seen
of the
measure
:
seventh
is to be
of Nos.
fourth
them
of
of
fifth, as
exercise
contained The
explanation
these
fourth
In
however, D7.
the
laid
course,
of
which,
mechanically
them
of
many
use
because
here
appear
chapter,
remarks
structure,
of
us
to
and
rules
their
only
allow
third
exception.
Bass
hords:
a
of
in the
only,
stiflf in
of this
in learoing
the
$
forced.
fundamental
adencing
test
7
^ife^i^^
exercises
us
introduction
appear
follows
assist to
seventh the
What
to
and and
because
nd
-P"
all previous
and
6 4
6
T
Tsr.
t
i
-"-
6 5
It
(S2
"
9i^^^
7
6
I
-(S-
7
f
4.
7
2
G-
"
1
"i^
^
6 4
"
7
6
t
1^
-"--
tizsL
1-
I
-+*"
7
6 4
6
'^" "
-"
7 8.
I
X.".
chord
122,
mental funda-
the
two
because
of
the
easure
the
of
undamental
In
the
A7-D
takes
Exercise
minor
is
t will not
appear
place
unnatural
131
Inversions
Through
erived
inversions
the
ominant
be assumed,
ourth
third,
and
The
variousness
the
lthough
econd,
in the
nsue
same
into has
an
There
he
is
need
as
open
ccurring
Somewhat Progression
no
of
new
-"
rule
that
before
was
before
same
with
the
the
sixthy
of
"
the the
fundamental
mony har-
inversions.
For
through
inversion,
augmented,
its
been
still explained
y
into
a
minor
will
progression
above.
2 "g
"
"
g
-"
"G
"
,,
IV
Only,
seventh.
equires,
::=:
T"i
!:
of
4 3
r
the
seventh
fifth, of
and
seventh
already
6 5 "
the
of
sixth
treatment
the
changes,
seventh
-j
the
of
in
as
introduction
Seventh.
the
themselves
shown
fifth and
third,
manner
thb
with
thira
the
of
second.
diminished
the
and
the
seventh
of
chords
already
chord
alteration
major
secondary
have
the
of no
occasions
of
and
that
Chords
Secondary
the
viz.,
seventh,
the
of
VII.
of the
which
arise,
chords
th
harsh.
and
the
of
of
progression
Bass.
chord
CHAPTER
The
the
where
stationary the
it may
and,
131,
a
with
of No.
used,
No.
of
exercise
second
in
egree
third
for the
the
of
in
little caution
all these
of
degree
seventh a
remarked,
progression
on
major account
chords
and of
^
minor
the
easily
fifths. more
their
concerning
of
the
Chord
of
treatment
the
Seventh
follow
may
of
the
here.
Seventh
Degree
in
Major. 6 5
6
4 3
not:
6
2
6 4
f. _
All
these
inversions
of
the
chord
may
be
used,
only
the
last, the
chord
of the
chord
s
passing
We
by
sixth
must
not
allow
crowded
ourselves
to
It
is only
omes
to
lie
following
important,
in
occur
only
the
of
be
cases,
rare
was
before,
fundamental
(see
fifth, and
and
to
are
chords
mentioned
the
sixth
in respect
misled
these
which
as
below
or
above
chords
in
position
133.
the
oonld
at
and
most
chord.
the
of
fourth
and
of
their
in
exhibited the
whether
positions
third
and
No
seventh
69), and
page
fourth
the
usefulness
of
the
sort,
134.
more
appear The
chord
the
the diminished
of
foregoing
the
to
similar
because
satisfying,
e.
lies
seventh
a
requires
seventh
fundamental.
the
above
manner
of
progression
g.
35
That
least
hat
the
reatment,
f
the
sixth
concerning
sixth
fourth,
which
of
a
the
chord
unsatisfying which
arise
through
into a
requires follows
resolution
third,
and
will be
second,
resolution
always
is necessary
fourth
the
of
what
chord,
of
the
chord
fifths, which
fifth, and
and
by
the
in this
the
careful
later. of
the
chords
:
manner
136.
to
e
be
regarded
oncerning
the
6, 17, and
18.
With
espects
f
is shown
use,
and
successions
inversion,
the third
for
adapted
of
hord
That
likewise
here
the
this the
inor
third,
faulty,
degree
pliant
in
chord,
already of
the
mentioned
position
such
material
major
; the
seventh
of
impart
sound much
of
above,
fifths, compare
no
similarity
will always
been
this sort
produces
seventh
the
has
of
succession
exceedingly
seventh
undamental,
as
the
mildness
of
also page
lie
as
abov$
augmented to
the
Nos.
29,
fundamental
the
difference, can
(page 76)
chord
with or
the
chord
below
the
to
the
second and
as
ca
ase
tlu
80
OF
MANUAL
HARMONY.
Exercises*
1.
2.
6 5
6 5
6
i
r-g-
4 3
6 6
3
8.
6 6
2
Wl
iS$:
6
2
6
6
73
s:
^
7
l^^isr.
6 5
6
6
jSl
6 5
-jsr.
X -flL
7
6
2
4
6 5
6
6
-"""-
2
:^
igB3
2
^S
6 6
6
1^=t 4 3
t
I
-"-
"g
g
7
^^^T=F
4.
6 5
6
2s:
g^
1S7 """"
6
:1=i
:?^
-s^-^-g-"-
5.
:$
6 6
6
7
7
T
iit^Eg 6.
6
2
6
2
^=^
3
6
2
2
^
12^^
"g-
6 4
6
^r=^:zs
2
I
-""(2-
6 6
6
7
7
:4--i::t
:5=?2:
=f=t
ii^
f
6 5
7.
-"-
I
6
6
jar
7
7
3
-"-
6 5
6
3
-s"-^
f
'^s^^^
F=f
.ZSL
f 8.
3
6
2
7
6
1S=^
^^
-"-
%
:"=??:
^ -""
f
6 5
6
s; -^-
9.
3
.7
^^
m^
7
B
6
6 6
jt
f
^^"
?=t: 7
7
7
6
$4
6
7
4$
,1 -fs:
33; S:"z:3:
:^|"p
--
"-
i
.a.
ja^ 10.
^6
4
^3^
i^^^ff^fft
6
2
E
6
1
jar
:^
t
"iB-i
g
SI
VIII.
CHAPTER
he
Chords
tone-degrees
varlotis
The
known
egree
that
rule,
chords
previously
else which,
under
hord
connections,
is
sort,
rogression
ress
the
of Decep^
used.
it
and
any
of
satisfying
thing every-
second,
If
is
this
of
downward
the
be
would
result
full application.
have
however,
either
the
that without
shown,
will
can
as
variousness
great
fundamental.
the
of
fundamental,
seventh; e,
upwards^
rule
the
connections
authority
inversion,
its
of
intelligible
above
in the
alterations.
hitherto
no
in
one
progress
resolution,
little positive and
or
seventh
the
completely,
as
necessary
cases
the
of
the
of
the
the
also
to
in
sure,
conditions,
progression
seventh
progression
irection
the
the
all
the
then
roduced, The
in of
other
of
upon
as
be
it has
but
subject
movement
depends
uch
far
thus
those
must,
seventh
shown,
hing
the
the
verifies itself, to
dovmwards^
In
than
otiier
Chorda
with
connection
Cadences.
tive
f
in
Seventh
the
of
can
remain
set
entirely
or
stationary
thi"
aside even
pro-
g,
9f
i3S.
i^:E^S^=j5=^;^g=3 This
ith
leads
chords
inds
to
us
the
possibility
tone-degrees,
of
chord-connections
of
n attempts
formations
new
at
follow
now
kind,
chord
of
that
the
to
of
in order
proceed
the
A
used.
remarks,
with
the
of
chords
hitherto
those
than
other
the
connecting
of
seventh
few to
known
be
to
according
able,
critical
rinciples.
We
begin
It has
been in
eventh
the
with
the
hitherto
manner
chord
of
If
chord
other
he
t
seventh,
before,
mentioned
ominant any
dominant
the
the
seventh than
natural
the
is
used
inclination
seventh.
called
the
of
resolution
cadence,
chords
and
that
of
the
of
the
cadence.
closing tonic
the
triad to
a
follows
the
is either
close
dominant
chord
delayed
or
of
entirely
aside.
The
e:!Cpectation
H"intment,
and
the
of
for this
natural
reason
these
succession connections
ominant
arise thus
cadences
chord
of
the
seventh
of
chords
are
a
disap-
called
CADENCES.
DECEPTIVE
Deceptive
hereby
experiences
everywhere,
does
not
where
result
the
in the
progression
tonio
triad, but
of
the
leadf
Some 1.
The
grees
connection
Connection In
a
with
the
of
progression
with
seventh the
of
seventh
trictds
by
de
degree.
the sixth
with
In
Major.
Minor. ^
li^^i^P^^^^^
This
^
V
V"
C:
effect
chord
77
this
of
(deceptivecadence)
of
the
seventh,
Jn
is not
progression and
occurs
more
%
the
with
/"
"
4 3 36
-"
o
Minor,
6 4
24
inversions
:
rare
Major.
^
frequently.
very
decided
so
is therefore
VI
V.
a:
VI
chord-connection
The
the
tonic,
chord
downwards,
a*
"""""
explained.
dominant
the
the
of
be
will next
of
that
than
other
them
of
varieties
6 56
^^ 0:
b"
V.y
Connection
the
with
better
""i^ Remabk.
ollows
^The
"
; they
This
are
g:^^^;5
easily
the
"
;[E
g
iDversions
of
the
chord
are
here
omitted
and
in what
of
lation modu-
made.
becomes
progression
r
m
with
attempts
6
6
-""
:t V.
:
position
7
f:
VI
degree.
third
6
0:
Vir
a:
VI
more
decided
under
the
application
:
7
6
7_
6
^6
143.
Viy
0:
The
inor,
connection
but
farther
this
a:V
the
with as
dissonant
triad chord
of
the
third
(through the
degree
is
also
fifth)will
augmented
necessary.
succession
6
7
t
143.
-
-"5-
a:
V.
IIF
%
i; VI
1^
.".
f-
3SSr
possible
^1
make
in
With
degree.
the second
impracUtxtbU
not:
in
Minor,
6
^=iEeJ^^I
P
144.
-^ Vi
C:
||"
With
the
/"
no
degree.
fourth
Major
V^
a:
In
:
6
Minor
:
6
6
6
Jg-
"'"pi
:^=s
-"
-f
-.^cTisr
*
^
:^:^^-
1^
Ci
The
f
V.
IV
connection
the
few
A
ible.
of
of
chord
beside
degrees
here
follow
them
Degree
6^
dominant
the
other
of
seventh
Viy
a:
before
those
:
with is
used,
harmonies
likewise
Minor:
or:
pos*
Sd
Degree,
6 5
6 5
2
seventh
:
8(2 Degree
:
the
of
IT
TT. "
-^Q
"""I
-i-
1
C:
we
Viy
itself
With
a"
-"-
into e,
greatly, a
Viy
viiy
other
keys,
the
progression better
afc=
A:Viy
AlViy
possibility
of
III'Y
new
VI
oonneotiivu
of
the seventh.
:
P^^^^g^^f VlyD^Vr
C:
ll"
Vy
Wliy
g,
doumward
not:
".
^
^
TT
modulate
xtends
z::^=5=:z:g=H:
"
-d 77
If
"M I"Dfl
The
C:
seventh
remaining
Viy
a:
BIYIlOry
Viy
F:
V"y
A:ViyO:TlI""
stationary.
14".
C:
8.
The
V^EbtV^
connection
C:VyB|7:V7
of
the chords
a;
Vi^
through
an
C:
Viy
ArV^OrViy
upward
progression
cventh. This
case
can
occur
with
the
common
cadence
(V
"
I).
ofthi
not:
^^^^^^^^^^^
49. 6
7
7
Ih^ Through
":
the
step
third,
a
of
becomes
he seventh
6
^ 35:
impossible,
Bass,
the
of
since
I
the
6
IB
^-"^
downward
the
octave
covered
progression
occurring
o
thereby
i
-"-
150.
m
s in any
In
the
case
1
faulty. voices
remaining
this
progression
of
the
fundamental
cannot
]m
ntroduced.
-9-
I
SJ^^9-
151. .O-".
Si All
these
b"
The
5=g"
s:
Examples
are
fundamental
^^It
faulty.
stationary:
remaining not:
"^^="2.
152.
E^^Hp^^H The
rgan
fundamental
point).
he following
serves
It must
progression
153.
here
as
however would
so-called lie at
be
faulty
stationary distance
a
:
firom
voice, the
(See later Beventhy
and
Through
""
and
alteration
chromatic
f
f
6 5
3
"^ jg
"
154
"
"^
0:
Ti"
modulation.
with
4 3
f
"
"
Ti
G:
6 6
*
^=Z1^
i
I
"^
=3E":
P
-JK C:
V"y
V.
G:
Through
d*
0:
vnOiy
contrary
motion
Yrj
Viy
F":
the Bass
of
into
modulation
with
other
eys.
p^l
65.
'i*'
V"y
C:
0:
7r
d:
V^
V"y
a:
Bjj: vnOiy
d:
0:
vii0.y
F:
V"y
(See
The
f
foregoing
of
of
object
harmonic
of
manifoldness
chord-connections
The
combinations.
possible
he
catalogue
them
its
and
progression
to
was
No.
above.
only
gives
V.y
call
an
149.)
indication
to
attention
capability
for
con*
truction.
Concerning
n
decide
only
nly
a
with
like,
the
of can
; in short,
lead
to to
original,
appear
ntention
would
such
not
new
of
of
of harmony
in
the a
forms
instances
few
7
6
so
7
7
-S"-|2-
56.
X
-
u
-"-
3t
2.
!^^
6
f^
4 3
6 4
:x::q: -^-^
6 6
6 4
2
6
or
in any
Eocercises.
8
peculiarly
apply
apparent.
6 6
possible their
succession,
motive ; to
strange
and
6
becomes
their
music,
application
probably
use
right
situation.
piece
combinations
would
be
a
the
produce
their
whole
criticism
chord-combinations,
introduction,
their
of
through
similar
since
their
character
speculation,
pon
to
attention
voices
and
cases,
especial
proper
particular
eading
he
in
these
of
worth
weight
ythmical The
the
6
7
formed
thought,
them, case,
succeed,
and
however,
in ordei that
the
-*
3.
6
3
7
6 4
6
7
6 5
2
ti
\%~w^-^"^-
t=f 5
iS
6 6
6
-9-P-
^C
t
6 5
6 5
6
-^
6
7
6
m
-JpL
t
""-
-"
It
6.
7
"SL
3
openpotition,
6
6
7
6 5
6
6 47
^
ia
5::?i":
10-
-"--
t
2s:
"F
f
67 6.
3
Pi^i
-"-
let
6 5
6 4
3
6
4"
3=4
3t -g'-'C^
tl
1=3: 3S:i."?:
dduced
; farther
84
page
Secondary
more
here
be
With
a*
on,
To
without
regular
5th
be
can
exercise
abandoned
has
of
chords
adduce
to
reference
a
leading
Connected or
with
cases
all
i of the
of
Keys*
secondary the
Chorda
with
kind
chords
of
be
would
as
the
seventh
impossible
object. progression
the
of
seventh.
"-
57.
,g^ C:
im
^^fef^^^l^i^i^p "
-o
n.y
m
iii^
ui^
fe
IIP
VI
IT.y
0:
Tlliy
IV
letter: "
IlOpy
-
BrViy
not:
a:
"
V
"
IViy
Toices
agaia
Tone-Degrees
other
7
-ti-e"-
Seventh
the
of
connections
follow.
it would
it
Harrmynies
of few
of the
position
"^en
IF
i3:
-"-(a-
The
"
6 4
6
5
s-
"
7
6 4
6
1^=?:
6
6 6
Remabk.
ay
6
-s"~^
1^
t
A
3
H:
22:
8.
he
4
^n=
g!Efe
t"
6 5
6
jy
6
iiaJ
I^
--"
7
6 4
7.
iiB
7 "
7
.
V
VI'rGiViy
A!
nf*fr
":
mOi
not:
i=i^P
""*"
C:
Remark.
reason
The
C.
the
niy
last
uiy
C:
d.
^ZEJ^S
The
IV
Uff
progression
hord
the
of often
lso
Iliy
last chord-succession
ing
The
sixth
appears
chord
of
fourth
between
called
erost*
this
chord
the diminished
-""-
delay
is often
used
the
of
oaden-
inserted
the
Its chord
its resolution,
and
seventh
a
triad.
tonic
the
of
^E
gg^^^g
fifth, through
the
to
6 4
III
It forms
used.
degree
second
and
so
6 6
III
TI
is often
the
of
the
stationary. 6
C:
in
tiiOi
later.
5.
a.
d:
niy
lies
good,
follows
which
of
V.
a:
is not
example
explanation
remaining
seventh
C:
viiO,y
o:
the
why
found,
therein
doHoti
the
of
as
in like
sixth
Example
in
c" :
manner
en 4
Tb
o:
Here
he
the
also
sixth
The
fact, stand
owers, It
and
eventh the
161.
the
through
the
chord
the
of used
the
in
appear
o
its progression
before
for particular
the
out
technical
representati
and
the
possible.
addition,
If
combination.
be
to
skill, educate
and
aptness
lie in the
[practice]will as
bringing
left to
is not
; this
composition,
practical
productions
and
the
to
produce
remarked
above
none
be
to
Both
fundamental
form can
be
first
at
relation
exercises,
only
of
might
it will
therefore
and
be
may
of
advantage
chords,
of
same
intellectual
render
criterion
ombination
it
works.
musical
to the
voices
delayed
chord-successions
The
relations as
in about
here
may
the
preparatory
of
such
of
investigation.
insignificant
and
is only
progression
and into
gained so
V
combination
practice
steemed
tudies
natural
mechanical
nsight
I
vuo^O:
fourth.
and
ersonal
n
The
"
C:
V.y
G:
Tiff
^E^pi^p
that must
the
always
this is pure
faults,
mentioned
relation
and then
be
of
the
regarded
the
the
remaining
chord-
cases.
Exercises* 6
"1^
7 5
6 6
6 -9-
6 4
i
6 5
2.
6 6
7
6
-^
53
'9-
1
"
SL
-"-
-fS=:~"
r-
"f9-
8.
6
5
4 3
7
7 5
6
7 5
6
2
6 4
6
6 5
^
^g$^^
r-"
^5^="-
is:
i
t=t -"-
:SL
.t"ii
4.
6 5
5
6 4
=d=a:
"
7
7
7
i
T:E^
-"
6
6 4
6
6
-"-
t
5.
6 5
3
6 4
7
T-"-
:?z: -g-
-""
+"
-9-
6
6
5
4S
7
6
6
7
1=?
"
i^
-
ij-
-""
:s:
3i
7
6.
3
6 4
f
6
51
fc^
S
"t 2in:
6
6
H-
-""
^1^
6,
5
ft
^^
^.-.-.i^siz:^. :i=P 6 5
6
87 "
6
675427
2itit2
^E
8.
."-
T5"
AT
^
"y.
7
41
-""-
:5^::a
il^Zi
f
4 3
6
6 5
Vt
IS-.
^"p$E^^Eg
i
t=:a :""
Rehark.
ecause
^liiaDy of
"
they
also
would
the
based
are
The sixth exercise
f
6
cases
upon a
makes have
adduced
above
modulation,
little
become
smoother
is not
which of
application
and
not
could
be
taken
particularly
modulation.)
less stiff and
up
in these
explained Many
strange,
the
of
by
the
exercises, until above
later
amp Ex-
applicatioD
modulation.
CHAPTER On
In most
Chords
text-books
of are
the
Ninth,
found
IX. Eleventh
extended
and
discussions
Thirteenth*
respecting
these
chords
ormations. The
views
which
can
be
plausibly
maintained
respecting
them
are
vajA
Either^
6
real
that
J
they, or
ensions,
nversions,
ecause the
ystem,
their
case
of
without
thereby
and
treated
and
regarded
as
doctrine,
the
which
it might
many
fond an
as
of
harmony
of
conceiving
especial
chord
a
reli every
taught
and
under
definite
difficult and
more
much
a
are
named,
chord-phenomena of
omitted
simple.
afterwards
was
be,
chance
doctrine
whole
more
much
those
as
well
four-
the
be
must
their
chords.
becomes
accidental
the
made
for other
sris
through
(since in
intervals
the
stationary.
especially
obscure,
or
to
remaining
voice
also
belong
either
y
use,
tones
their
ninth,
arranging
their
and
mistaken
the
of
;
a
of
of
explanation
however
tones,
account
of
thorough-bass
so-called
ombination
more
easily
chords
ts treatment,
on
extended
or
then
are
second
old
be
chord-formations
explanation
very one
RBMARK.^The
f
the
case,
becomes
they
the
unessential
accidentally
movement
oiced
In
as
arise
first
the
is to
intervals
of
combination
;
chords
Or
In
this
that
iffuse.
Without
harmonic
the
to
the
order
to
once
t
In
be
ill
If
and a
add
is known
a
the
to
ninth
the
ones,
simplificatio
disadvantages,
formation
determines
us
II.)
these
of
class
which
possible
this in Part
respecting the
reasons
unessential
chord
added.
dominant
the
the
under
theoretic
real practical
view,
remarks
the
accidental
(More
clear
into
enter
without
last view. gain
to
with
system
shown,
we
hich
here
able
of formations
kind
his
of
being
name
of the
chord
dominant
the
of
a
seventh,
chord
of
chord
arises
the seventh
and
inth. In
This
the
nter
re
chord
dominant
the
of
major
we
find the is used
chord
in minor
major,
in the
pure
of
the
seventh
;
and
fundamental
In
:
Minor
:
i^i^li
162.
In
Major
cases
the
harmonic
minor structure,
itself, with of
the
ninth. as
preparation
following
sort,
in similar of where
the
relations ninth
both
tones
free
1^1^^ 163. ""*"
^
^^^m to be
censured
on
account
of
their
stiffness and
want
of
or
conneotioiii
better:
64.
far the
How
first
examples last
to
ensions,
and
the
xplained
until
later, in Part
Remark. the
f
From
"
heir
cadencing
the
the
the
of
in
that
the
sus-
be
cannot
of
chord
which
chords
the
of
form
to
chords
of the
the
seventh^
of
e.
seventh
able
other
is omitted,
the
ch.ord
be
to
the
of
of
the
order
dominant
themselves
are
fundamental
in
minor, to
the
; likewise
before
analogous
chords the
and
of
derive
they
fully
ninth
manner
these
that
is added,
to
chord-formations,
major
treated
chord a
in
ninth
bave
in
accidental
belonging
as
reckoned
II. the
we
progression
ninth
other
of
wliich
it is said,
since
which
chord
from
seventh
eventh,
o
degree^
seventh
iminished
the
be
to
are
g.
65.
Through
f the
this
seventh
ollowing
he
arises,
first, the
the
with
the
of
Viy
o:
^7
7
in
degree
seventh
Viy
that
complication
major
;
the
one,
we
must
natural
accept
two
of
chorda
is the
of which
cadence
:
as
other
to
way^
from
derived to
refer
i
p
166.
the dominant
chord
character
the
the
of
of
the
seventh,
leading
tone
it remains
while
upon
the
which
the
above
ples sim-
chords
est
That
many and
eventh
till
more
ones
are
to
which,
simplified
succession,
strange
applies to
and
the
they
to
chords
frightful
16T.
p
also
explanation
just
as
without
to
according
theory, measure
is
and
introduced
be
accept
the
renders
ninth,
and
That
The
text-books
complicated,
reatment
greater
musical
no
chords
of the form
of
secondary
necessary,
of
eleventh these
V
13 11 9
7
7
Ji
from as
well
the
the
those is the
i
will of
of
the
formations none
in
these
of their
whole
suspensions. to
according
ninth,
and
chords
since
whereby,
respect as
chords
harmonic
many
preparation,
practice,
the
of
little
differ in
the
of
in
apply the
following
a
more
stil
thirteenth* :
In
four-voiced
\h{\ pure
the
through
ince,
as
imply
e.
can,
of
omission
necessary
suspensions,
they
movement^
of
course,
never
intervals,
many
they
be
applied,
will
appear
g..
i^^^^^^ 16S.
s
I even
nd
in the
polyphonic
their
character,
from
appear
without
all, in
t
they
here
hanging
also
they
movement
the
will not
suspensions
preparation,
distinguish
; in
the
they
can
themselves free
more
be
style,
as
regarded
notes.
X.
CHAPTEK Alteration
hromatic
Fundamental
the
of
Altered
Marmoniea*
Chords.
The
armonies
has
Either
Or,
double
a
it produces
it gives
to
the
Modulations
a.
Through
major
formation
new
a
is altered
triad
the
diminished degree
second
triad
B
in
El?, the
C
Through
El? and
61?, the diminished
b"
and last
keys, New
lYO
."E
minor, two
viz.,
or
minor
the
"
second
alterations
Cl? major
are
and
triad
not
hitherto
in this
used
by
tw.
there
manner,
arise
seventh
degree
in
^a
major
or
;
triad of
of
the
seventh
degree
of
DJ
Bj? minor.
transpositions
of
the
same
Cj|major.
Formations:
:Sr
D
;
degree mere
the
of minor
Through
ther
fundamental
of the
:
Cj|,the or
minor,
The
intervals
i^^NM^^^s^pSg^^
.69.
ajor
several
modulation,
the chord
If, for example,
or
:
effect
a
one
of
alteration
chromatic
i=^{^gi
chord
into
OF
MANUAL
92
hy
through
lly
HARMONY.
(passing tones) ;
-tones
have,
they
however,
harmonie
n:
value.
It is otherwise
formations
the
with
c
at
e^
and
which
harmoni
maintain
(accordliche)significance. first form
The
THE
This
43)
; it appears
n
major,
from as
xplanation,
the
in
tone
third
of
degree
in minor has
as
situation,
first fourth
the
of
been
previously fifth degrees
and
j
(see page
fifth.
(G^) to
its progression,
also
the
following
next
is determined
which
(A)
through
is easy this
o
tone
interval.
augmented
p^^S
"""
this
raised
passing
the
upon
triad
as
often
chromatically
with
Its origin
(Gj()as
more
name
TRIAD.
however,
seldom,
but
entioned,
before
the
under
AUGMENTED
found
was
chord
known
(c) is
triad
the
of
i
'h^^ s~^
f
*a
1
The
inversions
this chord
of
6
also be
can
used.
6 4
I
6
6 t
t
l^^^^^^l ^
C:
Although
IV
these
change
of
IV
chords
the
of
reparation
apid
I
the most
fourth,
augmented
harmony
the
for
appeared
they
in passing,
part
can
viio
free
enter
also
or
in
through case
of
:
i
lj
"" (I
t
r
f-
"
f
1^3. 6
3t]
P To
the
hich
occurs
ourth
degrees.
SI.
174.
triad
augmented
The
most
triad 6
7
b%
"
be
can
frequently,
augmented
1
"EEt=E
but
in
not
added also
the
connection
6
6 6
%
%
the
only
4 36362626
of
seventh
major with
dominant
the 4
dominant
seventh^ the
first
seventh
fS
9S
4
4
and
:
b.
In
connection
of the first degree
the seventh
with
jlrp
^"^
',
ftp
"^
___^_
:
Q
_
Y5.
fe*
^ C:
C.
I-r
the
of
7
6 6
6"
"
"
"
-^
Q
"
i-
triad
of the fourth
jy 4 2
6
6
g
r
g
"
"
"
s
g"
"
r
o~:zg
:sr:
these
all
IV/r
viio
various
has
I-IV) treated
chords
S
;;"
been can
of
progression
the
: some
used
be
also
however,
examples,
of
chords
with
used
Bass
cadencing
sion, progresmay
show,
degrees^
other
Bass.
the
of
far,
thus
chord-connections
(e.^., V-I these
-C
I
C:
a
1
k^ "^
tnd
the augmented
4 3
"
"
176.
hat
-C
I
:
^
^
to
seventh
aiiz^nx
"
In
*^
IV
j?%" addition is very rare
egree
I
I
or:
6 4
6 6
7
7
6$6
6"6
6
-
3
6^
698
t' "
:
3
b
6
.1
If
fi^^e
ggi-gggg: I
77.
I :*=ita
rJrzJ: V.
O:
6 5
Ypf
ni
7
V
.-CL
cquire
occasionally significance
specially,
If
ach
i
if in
it is the harmonic
a
C:
province
of
formations,
o:
viiOi
C:
I^^'DiV
^^E
2s:
jOl.
Ij^'GrV^
hi
and
rough
sounding
through
the
situation
strange
certain
V^
-"-
m
only
J
?"-
6 6
^S^^i
C:V^e:V^
C:
i
d:vuo
6
i I^-zijjgi^g: 12
These
V.v
0:
a:V
7
I
^
IP
s-1
degree a
an
text-book it is also
inner to
harmonic
leads
call attention
its duty
to
they
which
necessity
warn
combinations
to
the
to
the
occupy,
and
them.
possibility
beginner
o
against
io
himself
occupy in
versed
out
the
clear
A
and
turn
speculations,
difficult, and
render
into sense
the
of
therewith,
occupation
the
simple,
from
the
he
until
harmonies
simplest
will
the
away
and
early
insight
the
and
harmony,
too
effects
of especial
view,
the
of
structure,
seeking
things
such
treatment
the
harmonic
with
fttU pure
simple
intentional
and
impossible
probably
fundamental
features to
thing
chief
is
o
secondary
matters.
Exercises* 6
1*
m
17".
5
5
6it
3
61
6
2
6 5
6t
6
61
-"9-
H
6t
""-
-G-.
ti
X 6 6 8.
6
6
isz:^
X TSl"^
%
7
-tir.
"^-
3
7 6
6S
6
NB.
3
6
"
6
6"
^=f
triad
seen
be
from
sed,
the
second
would
with
the
the
viz
formation
e
double
name,
the
which
this
formation
leading
natural
in
/
the
of
been
used, does
connection
in
before
voices,
even
with
not
sound
Example new
many
No.
the uih
I
110.
chord-formations
1
of example
70:^ .
diminished
triad),arises
(which
^
harmony
a
also
which
occurs
is much
:
THE
The
a
fifth has
augmented
(at NB), to
correspond
this, that
the
exercise degree
gained.
From
under
of
This
atural
fourth
i
:sL
-^
js:
^In the
6 6
6
i
-^
"
7
="
"
6
7
6
^
'JSOZ.
-"
"^^ 4.
*7
6
6 4
6 6
7
1-jGIZ
inor
6
2
B% 4 2
t=^
Remabk.
6
:"=?^
6 6
grl ?ie?
an
6
3=^
6
3
^m
s
I
V
2.
i3
5
"
6
CHORD
AUGMENTED
first inversion
of
the
above
chord
OF
gives
THE
it
SIXTR :
""-|^^i^^si According
ixth,
the
hich,
G
its
to
original minor,
chord
with
which
progression,
a
belongs raising
here
of the
is determined to
G
minor,
fundamental,
by
augmented
fourth
the
goes
the
to
the
degree
of
fifth degree.
xample
No.
roof
he
179,
this lies in
of
the
sixth,
ugmented
chord
Remakk.
oticed
of
fourth
sixths
fifth, the
and
chord
augmented third,
and
the
and
basis
the
of
explanation
o
o
on.
in which
chord
(the fifth
the
The
dominant.
as
like the
formed
of
sixth
its origin
augmented
nly
the
relation,
allows
chords,
The
of
farther
^The
"
chord
itself
shows
chord
harmonies
few
a
augmented
follows
hich
last
the
the
the
be
to
of
augmented to
referred
the
has
the sixth
original
chord
in
doubled
jus
later.
its
that
peculiarity,
be
can
chord)
See
the
to
fiizth stands
source.
same
the
the
of
third
four-voiced
the
:
oYcment
jsr.
180.
pI^^^^^pF=i^
f
the
remaining
iminished
owever,
original
(the
chord
in
a
open
very
in the
ained
ust
The
"
four-voiced,
the
BO
major,
better:
triads,
minor
or
169
of
an
mterval
170,
and
and
interval
an
formations
of
of thus
already
Thus
formation
the
in 0
major
of the
in No.
triad
1*70, d
produce
either
will
above
in
the
place
chord
inderter
ntervals
the
following,
which
i
in
open
posUian:
^
^ vno
in
bears,
many
text-books,
the
name
:
harsh
triad,
(hart ver*
accidentally,
in pass-
diminished
Dreiklang).
like chords,
ffy and
like
:
C:
This
be
will
hett"r
The
triad
found
coo-
investigation.
farther
no
needs
is already
triad
minor
diminished
the are
which
the
to.
eferred
ound
or
Nos.
alteration
chromatic
of
alteration
of
only
position.
chromatic
formations
three-
used
not:
Remark.
double
so-called be
triad),the first (fundamental position)can the third (second inversion), very seldom, also
but
oiced,
the
of
positions
their
if they
progression
progress
be
.may
one
proceeds
degree
so
called, appear in accordance
upvoards^
diminished
generally with
their
intervals
only
intervals,
downwards.
that
is, augmented
een, in part, already
he
was
seventh
also
mentioned,
to
where
This
(page 92).
added
the
chromatically
the
with
occurred
triad
altered
augmented
riad. Among
the
lteration
one
of
the seventh
of
an
receives
of
much
chord-formations
roduces The
inversions
Of
fc"
he
inversions,
these are
rest
The
ame
/on"i
s iPiy
:
f
6 6
1"4.
Jhord
used.
a:
the following
ihe
in the following
which,
j
p
I"8.
ives
minor
chrtMiatio
is
This
its third
of
raising
chromatic
in
the
seventh^
importance.
especial
degree
the second
of the
chords
secondary
remaining
1"^
q
the
f
3
is the
second
?^
IP
important
most
is much
and
used,
unusual.
chord
from
resulting
the
inversion
second
is
known
the
xmder
of
is based
Its progression
the
chord
the
dominant^
of
the so
of the
'^
1"5
FOURTH
SIXTH,
of
fundamental
the
degree
second
sixth,
hereby
r,
187.
fundamental
already
explained,
this
is omitted,
chord
the
arises,
(seepage
the of
progression
augmented
J^ with
FundOTnental
chord
179,
Chro,
of
the
in G
omission IhnndamentcU
dominant
the
the
i
of :
raising Viird
I
:
minor Aug.
of ihe
chord
fourth
:
I :g
of
nOi
nPi
No.
:
chord
i^
a:
for comparisor
to
which
With
I
t
94) ; the
186.
immediately
as
mm^
'k-
.a:
of
found,
most
is,
that
ii".
a;
the
THIRD.
chord,
leads
"P If
AND
this.
will
also
that
upon
seventh
THE
OF
CHORD
AUGMENTED
THE
te0^-
""
and
third
sixlh, :
Aug. the
"ii
chord siasth
:
i
*? ^5"
-~ff^-
BaicARK." the
f
Instead ean
hord
be
can
that
abeadj
however,
become
must
this is found
while
fundamental
of
the
be
added,
the
upon
this
of
the
of
through
96,
to which
one,
since
a
diminished is
seyenth
that
chord
augmented
harsh
the
was
triaa
that
added; to
considered
be
on
second.
the
chord,
tiie fondamental
of
ninth
the
whereby
SIXTH
THE
OF
CHORD
AUGMENTED
page different
a
formation
the
reached
Dreiklang) mentioned
degree^
seventh
here,
mentioned third
and
verminderter
reeoluiion,
he
be
may
fourth
sixth,
(hari
he
It
FIFTH
AND
rises.
Its origin
is
follows
as
: Fund"Mnental
vfUhcttt
Fundamental
v"Uh
:
ninth.
with
:
Of
2J
e.
3
^faEJig^^
iiOi
these
ented
^
5
i;
I
"*'|
:
b"
jf
a,
o/the
chord:
"
Inversions
:
etevation third:
the
chords,
chord
of
one
the
from
resulting
is best
fifth,
and
sixth
first inyersion
the
for
adapted
the
a,
the
use,
aiig-
others
rare.
e
Its natural
ffths
araUd
is likewise
progression
to
dominant,
the
but
always
produces
:
1"0.
These
e
boYC-mentioned
hrough
a
the
sixth
here
be
n
90.
and
regarded
into
as
the
and
the
is inserted a
third,
of
of
most
the
third
(the original,
Example
(a)^ or
augmented and
progress,
the
resolution
the
suspension.
ones,
unpleasant fifth
the
the
whereby
tone
before
the
following
in the
by
Bass
prolongation
to
resolution
frequently,
most
sixth
fourth
earlier
belong
of
chord
fifth
remaining the
whereby
(c)^ which
chord
chord
2
Behabk.
ord
the
or
do not
suspension), as
same
(b),
while
tationary
f
of the
results
an
as
ninth
skip
sixth
through
either
avoided
he
fifths, which
progressing
of
"
the
^The
addition
ninth;
the
of the ninth
has
ninth here,
does as
not
harmony
justifyexplaining
this
the
character
everywhere,
same
as
as
suspen-
a
answers
a
hord) requires
connection the
use
he
from
of the
the
of
was
origin to
view,
expressed
it
suspensions,
however
(asfifth
a
generally
into
taken
to
necessary
discusuon,
under
oppose
be
should
was
in the
ahoT"
it
and
received
it
mention
was
firs
oonsideration
be
intention,
the
not
here,
by
appellation.
ExerciseSm I.
3^
6 5
2
it
6)9^
6
6
2
s
-"-
f
7
3
6
6 4
t
6
sp
6
t
5
?c=i: t=2i
ISt
2.
7 7
-"-
191.^
6 4
3
i
i
'jq:
I
:a.
'O
f 8.
2
^m
7
3
I
6
f
I
f 3
"*.
3-
8
^.
-"-
6 5
3
6
J
I
6
t
-"-
"*r;)":
i!^^'
--"-
li:
At
s
the
this chapter ":"f in it for harmonic
close
opened
known
enerally
or
use
and
and
sense,
refer
had
long
A
discovered,
re
which
uch,
ut,
in the
iscovery from
Smce
that
verload
the
the
the
is unadapted
for
inner
healthy
forms,
on
use,
op
the
desire
immoderate
tion, condiin
a
occasion
transformations property
be
time
be
not
us
gives
common
with
may
of
unadapted
93.
page
became
may
germ
us
alteration,
harmonic
they
effort, out
whole
an
i
which
lost,
developed,
we
cannot
for originality, use
of them
vis adto
the
tion devia-
and
primitive. transfprmations
all these
venture
before
much to
the original
these
still longer,
field whieh
itself in its original
remarked
before
elapsed,
the
of
was
found
experienced of
broad
appeared
showed
forsaking
which
harmonic
new
e said, for the may
now
direction of
a
and
until
order
that
Much
use.
addition,
This
indeed
time
an
have
We
however
received
to
more
for
the
more
once
survey
formations.
Nothing
adornment.
once
we
adapted
worthless.
everything
ertain
o
it alsc
as
suspe^ions,
harmony
this
this, that
the
with
question
above
treatment
the
preparation.
follow
It would
n
to
completely
more
to
work
elegant use
of
them art,
serve
carrying
only and
with
thereby
more
out
of
for the
adornment,
ourselves
fundamental
simple
discrimination
if
be
and
we
do
reckoned
not as
it
migbfc
idea, wish without
to
At
the
close
mmediate
the
of
use,
of
exhibition still follow
may
brief
a
harmooies
all essential view
their
them,
of
and
their
varieties
erivatives.
View
of
belonging
Chords
aU
L
to
77^
""
TriadU
The
McyoTj
varieties
Minor,
Ths
Major Boole
Major
Of the Minor
:
IV
V
A!
Minor Cfthe Major
Scale
Of
:
II
m
the
a:
Scale
0/the
:
vno
a:
Triad
a:
augmented
Inversions o*
7%e
chord
triads
of
the
Minor
SeaU:
I
IT
SeeOef
Minor
under
IL
vn"
tfi
Scale.
Wf
see
(Versetzungen) of
0/ the eiwth. 6
Minor
w
Augmented
remaining
71
Triads.
^^^ 0:
the
Yi
Major
V
$
Diminished
The
:
Triads.
"E:^^M
B/"
8eaU
I
3
Cf
tffh^ MftmUlL
Triads.
i
0:
chord
Augmented,
Diminiihed,
Oftht
Key.
Minor
Triad:
the
of
or
i
^^= A"
Major
HARMONIES.
FUNDAMENTAL
a.
a
6.
The
:
the
Altered
Ckefdt,
Triads
chorda/
the
"
siathiindJourtA, 6 4
most
a^d
The
Varieties
of the Chord
"
The
dominant
chord
b.
"
Domiruint
of
the
Secondary
chord
of
chords
the seventh
Formed
alike
m Secondary
1^1
with In
chords
Viy
of
In
^
the seventh
In
8. Diminished
:
minor
lnMUfm\
m Uliy
triad
with
Til
minor
Major:
triad
vn"i
with
diminished
erenth) In
Minor:
m a:
6. Augmented
it"
In
Minor
a:
n^i
:
i 0:
Diminished
a:
seventh
i 4.
VIj
seventh
Major,
n"y
In
Minor,
P
I 0:
serenlliV
Vi
a:
Mafor,
with
minor
with
(ffi"
IV-
triad
seventh
seventh
major
i
2. Minor
the
Minor:
and
o!
of
the seventh.
of
Major
Seventh.
chord
(major triad
V.
b* triad
in
primary
yb 0:
1. Major
or
seventh
the
of
iriad
with
major
seventh In
$
ru9$f
Minor:
seventh
(chord of
the
diminialied
"
"" "" -"
OF
MANUAL
Inversions
ihs
h,
chord
of andJUlh
9iath
T%"
Hasth^
:
chord
fourth
of
ihs
c
third
and
the Seventh.
of The
chord
qf
ths
second
:
:
I 2
3
^^
"m
^
'JBL
aS:
changed) from
formed
triads
augmented
I
^
(oh"ohatigallt
ALTERED
The
Chords
the
6 5
n.
Ml
UARMONT.
(Yersetzungen) of
Th6
Om
w
OHORDS.
the
major triad
InMa^or:
m T
C:
The
!"" 1. From
the
iminished
augmented triad
minor
From
the
he following
he
The
chord
chord
of
raised
with
the sixths
formed
(so-oalleddouble
fundamental
of
the
augmented
augmented
of
:^u^_^ seventh
the
of
second
in minor.
degree
the
chord chord
seventh
of
of
of the
the
the sixth
and
fifth,
and
degree
second
fourth
sixthj
"
in minor
the
or
nfi*
third:
of
Second
Inversion
:
aug,
of
formed
the :
and
the ninth Fundamental toithqtU
f
the
from latter.
I
"^m
w
from
:
Without
Fundamental, the HfBth citord
third;
^both
With RaiHng
^pi
(Se
chords) : The
C"
d.
chord
triad):
i 2.
V
IV
i
102
MANUAL
OF
HARMONT.
CHAPTER Modulation
On
The
term
modulation the
thereby is arranged
to
from
a
the
of
According to
into
has
a
various
In
The
no
(einet Tomaitm). Formerly
signification.
later
the
another.
be
of Music
in which
manner
would
import
the
recognize
will be
Passage
the
digressive
pleonasm
to
according'
stood under-
harmonies
of
succession
is understood
sense
name,
was
sion digres-
the
modulation^
which
the
fication signi-
original
word. to
foreign
a
a
part
into
found,
of
and
vocal
key
one
is sometimes
rightly
way
XI.
of the
determine
and
farther
key) ;
discussed,
it will next
term,
each
occurring
in Chapter
on,
the
whereby
be important,
of
capability
(digression
modulation
XYI.,
the
learn
to
for modulation
means
latter is
the
recognizing
fully supplied.
more
A
if
arises,
modulation
harmony
a
to the
foreign
key
previous
ap-^
'pears.
The
to
reckoned
which
the a
effects
Thus
key
previous
in the
is then key,
new
now
long
so
forsaken,
wholly
harmony,
no
as
harmonies
the
and
again
be
must
to it, appears,
foreign
modulation.
Example
following
:
I
E^ "
^^
-"-^
4-
J=i
I
m
-fi^
'
o
o
192. 6
7b
6
^-
1=
J
"
7"-gOx
"^
or
is
a
belongs fourth previous
no
longer
seventh,
the
the
dominant are,
remaining
C
major,
(D minor),is
while
The
to
in
minor
it is doubtful
measure
key
D
to
modulation
as
to
chord the
chords
of
chief are
the
but
to
A
to
C
also the
of modulation,
ambiguous,
that
to
chord to
never
can
whereas is foreign
fifth
is, they
C|-E-G^Bl2,
minor,
major, or
in the
minor
as
D
C triad, which
the
be reckoned
because
measure,
undeniably
the seventh, means
G.
third
whether
to
modulation
e.
0:
d:
?^
the
be
to
the
lowing major folis unmistakable.
measure
of
G
in the
the diminished mistaken
belong
to
; all
several
Thns
G
the
to
ub-dominant This
"om
D
often
e formed
first through
in
as
fact,
be
to
decided
the
is
bat
major,
aisc
minor.
modulation
harmony
dominant
the
B
to
G
to
exclusively
degree
the
allows
chords,
succeeding
not
sixth
and
major
ambiguity the
belongs
triad
major
itself
modulation
of
firs
recognized
the
can
it
with
seventh
erivatives.
The
hat
he
it
:
odulation key,
itself proceeds
ear
musical
always
foreign
to
related
the
the
apprehension
hanrs\"r
belonging
as
a
of
to
one.
ruling
-"-
193.
triad
major ; in
ajor
key
follow
G
to
becomes
here
with
C
major,
and
the
^be key
to
it will be
following
the
D
of
ircv"5diately
most
first
chords
can
ter de-
out
IV
one.
for practice
exercises
discussion
farther
belong
would
major,
ruling
more
some
; for the
odulations
itself considered,
however,
dominant
which There
in
D
of
connection, as
ecognized
this
of
in searching
subject
see
Chapter
XY/
Exercises,
f 3
6 6
6Q
6 6
6
7b
a: z
94
.iS^
-^ 0:
G:
I
jOl
^^^
7:t-^
V.
0:
V.
IV
6 6
2.
6 -12-
3S:
J^-
I
6
^^Ip^. b
7b X
6
6b
4.
6
J
6
V
ISL
f
f
6
73
6
t
i
7
4"
niy
is:
f
S
-"-
35";y.
0:1
m
6
6 8.
I
TuOf
d;
"
t=t
6 6
6 4
6
t
:t
a
-2=25!:
6
7b
-
-G
"xt
6 6
6
I
|2-
^
g
the
in
in
for example,
Thus,
simply
apprehends
is nearest
which
very
9
msL
1S=^-
t
geij
^^
f
6
6-7 4-J
6.
."-i
^S
ejBT
MANUAL
104
OF
EARMONT.
6 6
6
6 4
6
7
X
m
-ill
ISL
"~ii" -49-
32!:
:"zr^
4 6.
3
fe
v=^
6
6
en
)B^ 6t)
31]
3
4
6
8
7
4:
iS """
""-
f
1
Se
St
:sL
-"-
"P--"-
t=:F
4
4b
3b
2
4 3
6 5
6b 4
6 4
6 5
1=1 fel^
^
9
fg
g-
gj^
g
=f^ 6 6
'*r-g!"
^
g^
g
-"
3St
6
6 4
fib
t
"
3t
6 5
4 2
3
iioQ rest
6
6
7
I
#
aec"iding
nombeM^
be
can
moiSuI"tion
oman
t 32
3fclj^
=5:
i^^
xercises,
6
6b
f
The
32
7
):=;;:t
i^n:
6
3= -"-
-"-
T=t
-^
6
:e
if^ 6 6
8.
6 5
fth
to ^^v)
indicated the
which
know,
the
in
the
same
letters
degrees
apon
manner
indicate
which
as
the
the
in
key,
chords
the
firs
and
the
in qmes*
PART
ACdDEKTAL
II.
CHORD-FORMATIONS."
FOREIGN
TONES
TIIB
TO
HARMONY.
XII.
CHAPTER Suspensions.
The
if,
etrical
nd
variety
monotony
A
new
our
the
of
places,
binding
and
harmonic
while
others
a
takes
chord,
particu
through
place
Measured
certain
the
of
connections ; if
simultaneously
progress
it
produces
following
the
no
character
sentences..
musical
of
change
verywhere
movement,
together
to
all voices examples,
previous
the
of
chaining
nteresting
heir
in
as
of
progression
simvltaneous
form
already
chords,
if the
arises,
one
or
the
several
component
thereby
a
and
of
do
voices
not
linger
them
parts
more
the
of
in
next
armony.
e
The
important
most
be
to
manner
linking
thus
of
harmonies
together,
the
and
is the
preferred
SUSPENSION.
This
arises at
oice,
which
in
osition
hord,
while
into
er
In
a
the
definite has
to
delaying
the
through
time,
or
the
others
tlie harmony
following
to
progress
connection
i
the
still upon
second^
later.
of
":
harmony
:g:
195. an
in such
and
downwards^
lingers
:
a
of
progression
degree
chord,
until
a
necessary,
one
progress
foUowiog
the
even
of
and
voice, a
the
that
manner,
in order tone
this voice
is pec ex-
which
to
occupy
of
does
the
it
the
firs
not
past
Soprano
the
later
oyer
pass
and
to
upon
tlie C
daring
B
in the
following
the
pi^"
of the
the entrance
chord,
second
:
manner
I
s'zzrirjiza ""
196.
^
Si^ Just
so
a
delaying
the
Tenor
^ ":
W;^s^
as
ct
a
means
two
of
elations
they
this respect
s
The
dissonant in the
ne
of
can
the
other
through
only
where triad
he
The
have
the
a
similarity
where
voices,
but
unusual degree,
the
[in of
in
the
common
as
well
be
sure,
chord] and as
combined
with
well the
a
not
In which|
contain
always
any
particular
interval
with
suspension
chord
the
as
necessary
resolution.
progression
as
in Exampl
the
of
entire
sixth,
situation
of
no
appears
;
progression
forms
suspension
as
with
of the
thereby
with
as
dis*
a
expected.
resolution
disagrees
character
the
render
harmonically
suspension
the
the
O4
Tenor,
suspension. the
give
they
is, to
appearance,
the
that
the sevenths^
disagrees
tone
and
preparation
where
the
form
they
since
suspension
the
they
rules
necessary
in
the
formation
of
the
:
degrees f
under
can
the
he
formed
2.
will, therefore, :
with
following 1. Be
uspension
the
position
examples
suspension
There
th"
through
is, that
appear,
through
require of
of
they
which
with
of it which
third
suspensions
intimate
they
character
above
196,
^
connection,
occur,
the
of
with
character
only
of the
more
chords
where
uspensions
A
harmonic
197,
the
roduces
for
situation,
No.
nd
harmony
interval
cases
voice;
the
intervals,
connecting
^
"a-
is characteristic
against
:f
No.
rT
197.
which
Example
:
i
That
from
be formed
can
suspension
of
onance
by
linger
can
be
its preparation^
a
descending
Resolve
three the
of
c*
voice
it must
conditions;
prepared^
progression
and
itself things
to
suspension
observe
in connection
itselfand
with
its position,
tha
and
The
a*
The
part
a
of
The
are
dominant
the
throngh
place
also
sevenths
often
; most
rarely
take
ean
suspension
triad.
a
of more
lthough
107
PreparoMon,
preparation
ent
HARMOSr
OF
MANUAL
either for
used
compo*
preparatioii|
seventh.
Prepa/raiion the
through
Through
Fandamental:
of the
octave
ti
^
*
i!
-
6
3
:g
"^
7
6
i^;
p 6
^-
I
I
C:
^r:^
m
"-""
"
^
0". 5 4
tr
"J" -JSZ
third:
the
Through
I
C:
A:vnOi
TI
the
./l^:
)
u
I
."-
3:
*
^
Ljfs: 8
J: ^1
"-
a:
6
I
^1
.
0:
V
O:
I
Through
the
dominant
I
i
-Q-
'M
0:
Tl
IV
I
5 4
I
m 6 6
-
3
.
5
6
^m
The
Yfv
I
takes
preparation
nters
at
viz., that
lieS)
the
suspension,
The
b* The
ts position
of
in other
suspension "
not
the
upon
this, the
arsis^
rule
be
may
preparation
but
IV
of
the
before
mentioned
duration
a
stesp^nsicm
(page 71) or
with
equal
itsel
ap-
longer
shorter.
Suspension,
entrance
The
the
a:V
place
Besides
thesis.
the
i
3?s:
tO-
Y^
x:tuOi
4
A
i 0:
I
.01
:
etvetUh
^.
6 6
3"
8
I
-"-
O"
riads
^
-O-
9
han
-G.
J
-O-
before the
the
suspension
respects can
should
appear
seventh^
only
the
at
in
in
be any rare
thesis
still
more
voice^ cases.
has
just been
particularly
before
an
mentlouc^! explalnc^^
interval
of ih
before
Bu"p"ntion%
Octave
the
Fandamental:
of the
-^
6 6
8
4 3
6
at
I 0:
4 2
^
H
V^
-
-
I
'"^"9-
J "7
"7
Belbrethefik^d;
"
""
32
IV
C-
Before
the
j{^
Concerning
irst and
third
hile
the
dded
to
That
the
act, that
it
owing
and
is not as
to
in
immediately seventh
can
be the
can
Example
which
never
come
6,
where
into
a
the
the
Thus
197. the
of
If
all.
the
suspension, seventh
i
character
o
a
dissonant
to
made
itself.
seldom
in and
at
suspension
be
may
No.
character
example,
second
shows
but
in the
a
called
Example
with
entirely
[the suspension]would octave,
perfect
will be
fifth, reference
of the
case
in connection
examples
chord,
suspension
poeitiona:
in
suspensions
remarked
fourth the
In certain
4
tbe was
which
only
rarely, '
hat
he
9
":
6
7
99.
he
I^
*
have
a
necessarily for itself
dissonant
suspension, be
is only
position
appears
formed an
in most
interval
(a)^
except
is diminished.
octave
".
i^^j^il
^
900. 8JJ
7b
r
7b
from cases
the
by
of
tion, reduplica-
as
in the
foL
In
first
the
The
C.
The
the
case
hy
voice,
Remark.
the
of a
^Ways
"
Here
a
one.
passing
tone
of in
ontained
t unthout
be
to
resolution
no
observed
that
(thetone
which
voice;
other
was
lefore,
remarked
is delayed
in
tht
by
can
he
a
suspension)
the lowest
or
later.
shown
voice
can
receive
harmony, better:
b.
not:
be
this will
Bass
the
only
to the
disadvantage
a,
as
from
deviate
which
resolution
of
ensues,
suspension
downwards.
step
it is further
The
be
will always
Resolution.
resolution
ame
seventh
e,
d,
not:
NB.
1-
J
01.
In
Example
a
s suspended
lto,
has
by the
they
use
B.,
the
he
Tenor
the
D;
in Example A.
suspension
reduplication is better,
effect
it
ecessitates
as
Both
in the
takes
place
Tenor
fifth
last, in the
faulty,
are
In
chord.
Example
In
of the leading
consistency
in the
be*
especially
fundamental.
the
Soprano^
G-, which,
the
receives
the
of
with
if the
following
C, which
to
reduplications
and
especially
A
the
c
third
the
concern
from
steps
c? at this
case
of the voices
:
movement
Third:
Fundamental:
202.
Remark.
^ays
ulty,
e
"
It
assumes e,
The
the
the
still be distance
remarked of
at
least
here, an
the
that
octave^
doubling that
and
the
the
of
doubling
fundamenlal in
is
tmison
g.^
suspension
th
may
voice
lowest
can
which
indeed
appear
lies next
voice,
to
commonly
in such the
proximity,
only
between
Bass
and
Tencr,
or
lowest.
the
Bass,
has,
however,
as
the
one
which
the
of
based
;
suspeDsion a
upon
leading
good
of
therefore
are
reduplications the
e.
voices,
if
admissible,
they
g,
art
,
fautty:
03.
The
oice,
faulty
progression
clear,
if the
is taken
f
delay
mere
the
of
the
means
which
in the
open
last example
the
of
progression
octaves
com be-
:
appear
1
204.
i
Si The
is the
relation the
same
fifth-successions,
the
with
are
which
covered
:
suspension
A
U-r
jOl
205.
"
^y however,
Here, the
case
of
can
the
the
in
fifths leading
such
1 are
will rule, which
considerations
covered
permit
We
condense
The
suspension
progression
these
of
does
the
unpleasant
into
remarks remove
not
will, therefore,
fifths of this kind
f through
ositive
the
-""-
since
general, the
position, the
without
voices,
to
be had
in view
situation,
gress pro-
unpleasantness
fifths appearing.
arallel
he
through
Bass
and
|i
hrough
n
as
suspension
away,
Soprano
the
of
movement
succession,
directions
are
of so
regarding
the
following
parallel
be
not,
faulty
other
that
they
them
octaves
:
fifths,'
and
the
ing follow-
:
however,
the
rule
voices do
be
to
not
a
unconditionally
is impossible
made
plainly.
To
compensation
appear
; to
too
rejected is
reject
them
for give
always
OF
MANUAL
The
he
the
sixth
the Bass,
is the
(or,which
chord
f
in
suspensions
same
fifth), allow
and
which
occur
thing,
before
no
of
HARMONY.
Ill
before the
oftenest the
in
reduplication
the
of
chords
the other
third
sixth
of
and
voices,
not:
I ^z::r^.
s
6 4 2
207. 6 2
-
-
I
X The
before
suspensions
fundamental
the
^
'\~G "^-
If
6 4 2
"
"
-
-
"
"
5 -"-^=*""-
"""
i
show
selves them-
fifth rarely
the
and
"~zi-
practicable. fuii:
d:=d:
'JSZ
i
IoIsq
-^1
ig:
a:
-JC
4 2
0".
-
-
"~T"
If
the
is given
^., the
the
at
chord
^m
r
Thorough-Bass
the
is, in
notation
examples.
one
time
determine "
chord
the
""
resolution,
the
of
^'-j
f
3*
it becomes
where
chord
its interval
voices,
upper
the
with
the
|
sixth
three
the
of
same
the
of
in
suspensions
previous
figures
remaining
1^
lies in
suspension
Bass
he
in the
contained
art,
the
of
"-
H
""g
indication
The
he
^
^
g
-"
9
75
g
necessary,
|^
fourth
and
sixth
from
7 6 4-.
If
the
lies
suspension
emaining
are
voices
in
lower
the
likewise
the
voice,
indicated
by
intervals
chance e.
numbers,
|ll"or
g.^
of in
the case
o"
the
f
chord
of
the
seventh
dashes
; the
4"
follow
which
denote
that
the
2-'
oices
retain
The
suspension
the
nd
their
lainer
tones
in the
concerns
the
Bass
is also
chord
corresponding as
during
latter,
the
set e.
by
marked the
over
the
of
resolution
tone
a
suspension.
diagonal of
stroke
above
it,
ia
which
resolution,
g. O^"
i
I
I 6
In
the
6 5
liSir^" =d^g::^^^3
isr
examples
the
first
B
""-
6 5
09. 6
s
manner
is
tmc^
chosen,
as
the
most
^kcercises* 76 7
3
4
6
_o^_
310.1^
0:
V.
IV
I
11
2
6
3
5=d:
^ 6
-
76
2-76
6 6
6
3t)
6
fe
0
66 4
)Br
6 6
6.
m
I
64 3S
98
-
^1=^ 3.
08
32:
g^.^"s^
-g
-^"
6
III
6
"!ee^
2-3
n^
OL
^
7 3
5 4
6O
7 61J 4-7 3
8
9
74 3
7 6
-
6 6
61
U-
s-
"
-"-
fl.
"
35!:
=f3 7^
6 5
643
6.
43-4
6
6
7
7
2
66
1-
IS
"-
"
-ffl
*-"
"a"-i
6 6
987
6 644 3$
6
8
7.
"^:
64 3
6
2
-,9-5"
6 2:^
6
"
"
(2-
T
W^^^M^^^^^i^
t=F
ffeJ
5J3-6 2
^ 6
3b
6 6
3"
4
"
8.
3
is
*"""
3
6
i^Si
a
9
"O" -"'-
8
7
^
-"-.-*-
6 6
6
2
6
6
6 6
6 4
7 3
6
7
7
6
-
3
2
6-6 4 3
6
4
.6-
^':p^
ng
^
~s" -"-
"
"
i
T 6
7
zzz?:^"^.
6 6
6
:o::^
It will
be
exercises,
to to
the
in
purpose
separate
the
the
voices
working
and
out
write
of
these
each
upon
and an
the
succeed-i
especial
staiE
OF
MANUAL
each
f
ore
particular
a
useful
i
exercise
preparatory
reading.
Here,
n the
clefs
hich
is be
n
"
reading
various
to
scores,
of
write
the
be conceived
of
been
every
by
to
allotted
be
to
sung,
knowledge
the
o
these
of
through
and
in the
which,
voices
knowledge
practice,
attentive
as
them,
The
musician.
voices,
clef
comparison
known.
knowledge
The
always
always
attained
already
in these
itten
ith
soon
very
Remark.
and
have
which
to
necessary
must
structure,
indispensable
those
ith
it becomes
however,
harmonic
ure
g
is in general
and
Yoice,
113
HARMONY.
of
instruments,
Soprano
the
is requisite
clefs
instruments
and
are
itself which,
clef in
tuned
are
which
Tenor
and
voices
many
since
and
clefs,
Alto
the
a
understand or
exclusively
occurs
more
an
way,
particular
Cur the
partially
affbroi
rarely,
facility
es^^ecial
i
eading.
The
enor, For
clef
is called the
for
is used
which
three
upper
Soprano,
voices,
Alto,
and
G-def,
the
lowest
the
Bass,
the
part,
vocal
F-clef
the
Bass
or
clef
before
used
s still applied. The
arked
ound
kQ
of
situation
[middle] upon
fourth
the line^
the
C, and
lowest^ e.
C-clef in
a
such
for the
indicates
always
Alto
that
manner,
the
upon
the for
third^
place
Soprano
the
for
and
the
this Tenor
C
i
upon
Tenor-d^,
AUo-eleft.
1:^^^
-or"
-or.
The
onc"
g.
Soprano-clefs.
w
the
of
(-r-
"II"
-or
common
most
compass
of
the
voices
itself in
exhibits
these
cle"
hus* 0
-a
-F
psn"p^
[=11=4:
I
I Z^HiF.
q=q: Boprano-d^,
^
I" U
3=i^^"
! :#"
AUo-cuf,
pEj=j=^E^r-r^ =#=ii:
Itm"r'eU/,
:W:
W3e^S
P-
#-^
I
^
i
"
I
"
^ 1
.
EARMONY.
OF
MANUAL
114
^The origin of these rarious olefs from the most simple foundatioii, from th" (commonly a system of ten lines, upon ^hich all the voices were so-called Tablature written, with especial designation of the lines upon which the principal tones, F, C, G,
REifi'AK.
interesting, its farther
stand)is
to
oAme
"
here, however,
explanation would
lead
us
too far.
The
of impressing
easiest method
probably,
to
observe the
voices, whereby found out.
Thus
tones
the position of the and which lie between
will be
C-triad, with
complete
the
clefs npon
accurately
the position of the
mental,
these
memory,
ia
C-triad in the various on
each
are
side
easily
doubling of the fonda-.
:
^-0 "-::G-
In tkt Soprano:
|F=S=?o 0
JniMAUo:
In ths Tenor^ '
\^
dest in ihs position eiath and fourth
the "^tordof the ofthe
The
J -0 """
:
"
#-o"
m
(JIZH
in these
carrying out of the first exercise of No. 210
olefs follows
here: 211. ^
BOFSANO.
"
^
jS.
-Q-
Alto.
-"-
4Z.
Sxte \
0:
TI22:
-"-
1
1
"
3
7
6
0 I
7 5
6 5
6 -
5 4
7 3
9
G V
of these
i
-"--
SL
i:^^
Bass.
-"
-P-
6 4
The
r-'S-
;;5^:
TnroB.
i
-ffl.
F
o.
IV
0 I
i
^7
6iy
O
II
^7
I
1^
requires, with all observance of the a skillful and a freer leading of the voices in relation to their position, since the necessity of a better position of the suspension working
out
examples
rules thus far given,
an often renders necessary even alteration of the position of the voices, to make as which we have hitherto always endeavored uniform as ppssibleIn this manner the open position of the voices will come, of itself,and for the close position where again be necessarily exchanged necessity
and
conformity
with the end in view
require it.
In tluB ezchangd
e obs^ryad Hie
can
never
j
the
of
i:% the
cates
simultaneously,
from
pf"Qkion
idwU
position
voices,
following
the
must
rules
:
voices
ecessary
the
of
one
by degrees
move
to
chord
transposition
one
skij: out
of
same
the
and
into
chord
thei
in indi-
(foreign one), except
another
of
or
j"the
ositions. Any
its position^
voice
if
canf"K*r:ahe
or
one
more
stationary
remain
upon
tonA,
ne
The
following
lainer
carrying
czt
of
Exercise
8
No.
of
210,
will
this
make
.
212.
8
fes
-"-
8
NB
e
=P=s:
ra:
:?ii=h
^
Si "el^ s"^
ALTIi.
5
:";
i
?!="
v^m.
jrff^
Tbnob.
-^
TSi
i^^
2:
6
8
9
6 6
7
6
2
6
6 4
6
6 6
fia:
"""
Babp
3^:
o:
f-^*="" |IE^
i
"
"
O
"
I
"
IT
"
-h-
7 7
F7
D
AOiy
V4
no^Bbim
^
Bk
D)
Bh
I
IV
I
F:
Ciy
F
7
V^
IBf,:
V.
^1
E3
"
7
4 3
6_
6-6 4
-
2
6
3
4
7
6
6 6
6
9 1-
T
is^
-^
"-
"
-|o
:?s:
a.
?:t:
6
7
:^^3
1
7 6-3
3
s: -"-
i^
g
eJ
.o_".
-"
o:
Diy
G
0
ViJ
I
IV
The
following
The
close
asure,
in
may
position which
0
Bly:V^ serve
as
in which
the
open
r
GO
n
g:
explanation this
example
begins,
and
ly
I
of
f{
AOiy
D
llOX-
V
7 7
G I
this treatment.
begins, remains
is forsaken
until
in
in the the
fift
eleventh
This
he
was
first makes
a
"b
lready
present
nto
better
a
better
he
skip
it forsakes
manner
the
; most
such
bove, a
ith
are
progressions
before
treated
farther
succession
kind
this
of
of, through in
a
fundamental
i
in the
F
by
the
tenth
Bass)
; in
skip
into
a
comes
suspension
is attained
through
again
measure.
isolated out
arise
to
cases
the
of
be regarded
direction,
e,
from
suspensions
(abbreviation)of
contraction
upward
the
Upward.
few
a
into
measure,
whereby
in the
in
only
the
Below
front
below
from
here
position
Tenor
the
of
close
if the
seventh
stationary,
Suspensions
Suspensions
in the
last the
leading
free
(as
place
Tenor.
and
its position
of
out
stationary
Soprano
the
of
take
can
position
At
leading measure,
which
remaining
chord
position.
and
fifth
the
remains
and
fifth, G, the
he
a
freer
a
in
skip,
(at NB.),
eventh,
ike
through
effected
the
sam^
g.
from:
i
4-4
S
313.
P=^ The
from
suspension
ression
the
of
-"-
below
leading
tone
take
can
in connection
place
the
with
pro
:
214.
lso
ith
with
intervals,
several
those
chords,
altered e.
levation,
which
half-step
a
progress
which
receive
upwards,
especially
intervals
augmented
through
g.
l=d:
"
31
15.
igE^
I 1^-:
g Observe
iiust
be
Remark
hich
here, in
"
no
^The
presented
inor,
and
4).
That,
which
that
other last itself was
in tiie above
as
voice of
the
before
explained
before, with above
the
the
application,
unfit
of
exception
as
chord for
of
use
it is to be
of as
(harmonic tone
resolution
brings
examples
(page 64) as
tone
us
the
Bass.
the
the seventh
fundamental
considered
as
tone-combinatioa
same
of
the
harmony. suspension
degree
first
(See of
the
i
page
leading
Of
those
especially
suspensions,
other
whicli
a
progress
step
whole
upwards:
b.
1U
^. -""
ai6.p
'
"ffgfe
*-
eg
^
^ "
"rt*-
me
theory
the
me
armonic
f
false
iously
they
1T.
however
are
be
should
(No. 213), faulty based
they
find
may
progressions
use
in
place
out
after
would
show
carried
progression
unfit for
and
genuine,
often
suspensions
shown
hich
not
their
of
unnaturalness
pronounce
must
structure,
these
the
themselves,
of
show,
;
and
for the
pure
the
the
practice.
manner
pre"
themselves,
upon
:
".
Suspensions
Suspensions
two
The
e.
uspension,
than
more
one
Voice.
one
at
voice
In
three
the
*
voices:
the
sixth
fourth
and
frequently
itself
shows
double
as
g, I
"s=d
219.
Movement
of
J
Pi^^iB
is^E8^^g=: I*!
=
reer
time
same
"z^"=^z:^l=::5:i=S=:zt=g=t:i^ of
chord
than
more
voices:
^^^^
is.
in
occur
can
Ib
in
in
Voices
the
Resolution
the
Sus*
the
of
pensions*
Preparation,
revious
ake
lso
he
he
in
of
takes
remaining
the
voices
place, voices,
since
stationary
during
its
chords,
becomes
one,
the
the
whereby still richer
and
resolution
of
usually
the
took
suspension
chords,
of
if, during or
of the
two
means
three
with
resolution
and
it remained
place
leading
This
by
examples
part
take
entrance,
Bass,
the
voices
The
interchange
of
the
did
which
resolution.
more
in the
place
not can
same
chords
and
manifold. suspension,
progress
at
the
several same
of
time,
For
by
example,
progression
Bass
the
of
:
930.
I
By
than
more
of
progression
one
Tii"^i
":
:
voioe
31.
0:
In
all these
uring
he
the
he
in
easily
mples,
present
JSuepeMion i^ith
a
the
same
view
of which
of
with
result^
the
occors,
in
the
seventh
of
three
as
all
with
and
could
and
chorda
o
above
F-B
progression the
use
and,
chords
ninth
explained
Bass
chord
conceroLog the
be
can
cadencing
ninth
the
to
the
in which
ninth,
secondary
a
of
harmony,
new
ninth, were
not
subsequent
es
:
three
with
m
^in^-i" *~o
"
j-|_g=i:g-^--g-T-jS "
^^
"
'
ninth
enters
which
better:
chords:
"
o"
'
^fly
"
"
o
"^
"
-a-
f
.^
f
I
free,
we
of
what
will
in
speak
later
said
in Chapter
oonne"jtion
tht
with
rgan-point It may
gainst
nto
still be
added
independent
such
inversion
i
ninth
J
"i^^
of
manner
same
chords:
33
lead
not
the a
of
places
the
of
where
a
regularly
part.
many
chords
h^
tuipendon
did
-""
oncerning
a
of
that
progression
itself in the
of two
many
the
and
simple
as
to
in explanation
IX,
ensuci
suspension
voices
component
remarked,
221
as
explanation
more
uch
by
Example
explained
above
be
remaining a
in Chapter
recognized as
anner;
here
^It may
expressed
are
hich
he
is, itself,
the
of
resolution
the
of
progression
"
ninth
the
examples
resolution-tone
Remabk.
e
I
as
chords with
completion of the
the
ninth,
the
fundamental^
was
impossibility that
the
latter
may is
IX,
apply, brought
t};^t of
as
a
bringing
into
reason
them
immediate-
-'-^^m f
aa"-^^^^ In
the
before
t stands e.
oices,
four
manner
same
I
tone,
I
r
be
can
chords
harmonic
a
^
the
with
applied
is not
which
I
in
contained
i
suspension, the
remaining
g. 2
m
gg
-2
3
4
1
3
2
4
i
-Gfi^-
-iS-""-
f
I 6
5 4
9
331.
6
i is:
-^
^M
-"-
IV
0:
n
i
1
-Q.
VI
vno
Exercises, 6 4
"
1.
7
6
9
6 4.7
5 4
6
7
6
7
"7
ii3i
35.
r-te*t="
-""
-Q-
+
7 6 "-
6 2.
2
82
6-4
6 "
6 46-
4 3
6 4
7
6
T
(O-
^iiif=^-=^
?Srl7(0
i^Wp
g-
"q: 6 4
ilt
6
6 73 4-
7
3.
3
6
::*
4 3
JBT
5 4
f
:^
-;*"
71]
6
9
4
1:
X
m 6
6 6
9 7
6
X
7
^
JBT
^ 4^
6 4-
9
le: 5 4 2
6
7
s
^-i.
6
6 4
7
9
if
is:
S^J
t
6 4
-
6
6
-
_8
X 22:
^"i
jt:
" t
6 4
6
ii
Lx
6.
6
7
6-
6 4
6
"
-I"
IIP
t
t
2
x"\
It 6
"
7
6 4
6
tT=?2:
6.
8
7 4 2
6 4
%
66
7 4
6
9
ie
3
3
7
2
6
7
7
2
6
4
7
4
-""-
i^
t
"fs:
t
3^
5 4
6 6
6
i2^ffi=
"y.
7
i
^
S
7 4 3
3
0
Sttz"
7
2 4S-
f"-
i
s
3
-6-43 -"9
#--P-
iprzr^
t
5 4
6
8.
6 5
2
8
"P
6
7 4
"
6
t
:t=F
ifi^T
77 4
6
6
3
I
2
6
5-
-
6
9
7
6
9
43$
.3
m
f=^
JQ.
t
X
t
Between
and
stispensian
resolution^
^
^^ "i=;=J:
f
other
tones
he inserted
can
in
ths
voice.
me
These 1.
be
can
Tones
:
belong
which
to
the
chord,
"
Tones
rJ=it4 g^-ra: ": ^
^iijs!:
^
-"u-
foreign
^
27.
g.
-U?"
^
ro
2.
e.
4-^-i
1-
26.
to
harmony,
the
ti^g
changing
e.
notes,
-o
**
g,
"
isl"
: "
rft
to:
:o2: -"-
The
explanation of
xhibition
t
-
Instances all,
e.
the also
of
these
passing
changing
and
in
occur,
similar
and
which
the
notes
found
farther
through
no
g.
"^
I
i "
this
tnanner
:
I -"-X
"2?^
in
r
-s^ -
^^5
"
the
on.
receives
suspension
Usually
33".
is completed
instances
r ^^
^^
resolution
29.
Anticipation*
The
anticipation is
ion,
oices
han
the
opposite
others,
and
notes
eading
the
ostly
in
Bass
the
S
g"
or
i
a
not
In
:
-4.
to
the
of
it i
SMferal
voicea:
" r
fgg- -g"
f"
o
I
J-J-
-^
3zs^ =33?p"
manner
g.
In
j=.
earlier
harshness
e.
:
i-
more
unintelligibleness;
anticipated,
Soprano
the
1-^
this
the
all, since
or
them.
expect
movement,
slow
are
to
us
one
sutspen*
heard
be
to
chord
amount
which
this, that
allows
at
would
measures
of
in
and
the
than
used
in
consists
division
metrical
here
rarely
following
next
seldom
more
rTrTf
g""
CI
^
^^T=t f=t The
hat
which
is not
notes,
The
the
for
example,
a
is
ormula
intended
at
by
but
chords,
rythmical
merely of
movement
;
hich
have
they
or
the
of
harmonic
the
the
under
however,
latter,
form,
with name
formed
are
not
after-striking (Nachschlagen)
of
significance. here
can
voices
comprehends
; the
mistaken
in its metrical
voices
instruction
be
to
the
of
movement
musical
general
anticipation
hem,
this
of
similarity
yncopated
y
the
appear
""
W^
and
occurs
Anticipation
"
latter,
duration,
long
parts
"egg
the
the
which
30
is
before of
shorter
which
of
voices
issonances
of
tone,
tones
some
allow
With
a
of
(Vbrausnahme.)
tone
be
can
the
of
entrance
be
also
freer
under
other
anticipated,
chord,
as
some
in the
stances circumthan
known
that
closing
: or:
:{:
:{:
J-
i^
231.
J.
rsc:
W^-
I ZSi
a.
^
^
" As
antithesis
armonic
tones,
to
anticipation
which
has
a
may
yet
similarity
be with
adduced the
the
aftev'strikingof
suspensions,
in
so
far,
as
ially
as
its character for which
ovement,
; the
essions
ingly
The
it also
reason
however,
suspensions,
in greater
or
in
more
the
always
appears
^ppear
under
metrical in
and
more
entirely
rythmical
extended other
suo*
conditions,
numbers.
Bass
following
itself
expresses
be
would
a
succession
of
such
tones
after-struck
:
Allegro,
92.
I
lj.^AAj,Al P
i
;#=?2-
t"r
Here Leonore
"
belong
also
would
(No. 3)
of
that
unison
Beethoven
from
passage
the
overture
:
t
"
.T"
r
erese.
i33.
"
I "
U
"
\
"I
;imj
V.
s
I 11 I "
-a-
i^Efe^
fe"
"BPrr"
1
L
"
_I
te
P^^
"
Ste
(_ f==F
U
1
dEO.
^~.
f
"
^i
I
"
"rn
to
MANUAL
OF
EARMOSY
XIII.
CHAPTER
Hie
An
especial
by
rises
manifold
means
even
or
tone,
one
upon
tationary
of the harmonies,
character
one
of
than
more
by
and
Voices.
Stationary
JPoinU
Organ
128
means
one
the
of
a
and
the
of
voices
remaining
thereby
chords
of them,
mingling
accidentally
ormed.
We
frequently
a
f
the
cadence
ontinuance
of
t, continue
their
If
the
the
which
middle
begin,
should
harmonic
tones
prolonged
^Many
"
The
tones,
ominant
;^ they
it is
in the
Rema"k.
by
stituted
The
oices
ules, in
nd
34.
many
takes
general we
some
a*
the
always,
without enter
the
third
without
may
Organpoint
npon
lattei
the
the
t
reference
are
called
TONES.
Organ-Point,
plainly
voice to
follow.
the
the
as
the
the
particularly
examples
voices,
STATIONARY
name
well
during
regard
more
other
of
too
as
lower
next
point
during
tone,
sustained
for remaining
betray
connection,
the
that
so
the
at
but
station'ary
inoorreotly.
the
are
tonic
and
have
been
together,
occur
with
place,
conclusion,
called
oa
also
adapted
composers,
harmonic
Before
oint,
Attempts
"
last
these
also
beginning
the
at
[Pedal Point] ;
occur
are
which
well
apparently
voices,
VOICES
give
as
movement.
Bass,
STATIONARY Remake.
long
a
with
the
at
ORGAN-POINT
f such
Bass)
the
and
remaining
lies in the
tone
this
in
as
composition,
here
in (particularly
meet
tonic:
triad, to
the
the
ear
the
stationary into
the
the
later
times
unnatural
progrsssion
organ-point,
assumes
in
which
of
the to
according conduct
and
of
the
far sought.
remaining the
known
harmony,
tone. manner
of treating
the
organ*
b,
MSE -"-
-"-
or:
:t
|^f_#sS^^
I-
-0-
n:o:
I
9J"e;
both
Upon
In
these
are
following
The
1.
the
at
"-
:
chords
marked
by
remarks
entrance
time
same
those
examples,
belong, The
^
f^
I
.-sr "^"
to
the
treatment
for
takes
the organ-point
of
the
does
tone
moni har-
not
cross.
a
serve
may
Bass
which
place
the
of a
at
organ-point
dejlni
rythmically
;
2.
By
3.
The
ith
one,
f
the
means
hrough
last
to
chord
chord
first takes
the
which
the
of
Bass
harmonically
tone
belongs
harmony
he in
likewise
must
organ-point
fundamental the
not
succeed
hords orier
to
be
is only
to
the
;
triad,
the
as
sixth
organ-point
digressions
be
found
in
that
the
chords
but
harmonically
the
third No.
a
of
by
commonly
234
a,
C,
division
or
period
d^
mean?
or
b^
at
fourth.
violating
in
close
and
Example
frequently,
too
or
second
and
further,
other
the
avoid
a
taken,
each
which to
of
chord
should
thesis of
beginning
the
at
place the
upon
and
Care
hich
a
of
it,
Tho
f
n
dominant:
the
3i:
SiE
%me
o
upon
the
holding
are
foreign often
firmly
the
Bass
interchanged
belongs. character
to
This of
the
together
tone
with
is necessary, organ-point
of
various
Thus
following
the
be
would
organ-point
in this regard
faulty
:
^
*
U-i-^X:^
I
J
^
|i^^^#|p^S
35.
1^ ""-
The
ecomes,
in
eading.
o
case
Alto
the
organ-point
measure) by
not
and
the
234
progression
by
is determined
is seventh
it
that
circumstance
of
leading
the
conditioned
belong
also, accidentally, the
a,
be
will
progressions
Tenor,
harmonic
of the
voice
should
No.
the
movement,
fundamental
harmonic
in Example
first
the
voices,
emaining
even
four-voiced
a
the
necessary if the
Thus,
(in
in
Bass,
organ-point,
all
this voice,
harmony.
the
the
of
the
to
next
Therefore,
by
n
lying
voice
the
Bb
of
the
to
the
ass. If
the
lose,
hird
organ-point
no
plagal the
of
above
be
can
close
adduced
dominant,
the
upon
stands
formed e.
rules,
it,
upon
is often
as
as
the
cas6"
from
already
appears
at
the
the
g.
36.
The
plagal
however,
can,
close
ensue
the
with
tonic-:
the
of
organ-point
37.
fe
i^
The
end
of
ts entrance.
lace
arlier
In
through
nstances
such to
the
the
a
as
is
organ-point the
at
No.
harmonic
brought
eicamples
cadence.
In 236.
indeed
this
The
leading,
and
case
to
7esz
be
forward
as
carefully
above,
this
it presents
organ-point then
just
the
can,
third
no
treated
always
difficulty,
however, rule
E
G-"
also
is to be
ab
takes
iq
except pass
over
carefullj
OF
MANUAL
126
j
I
"
-)
BARMOSY.
J -^ Lj-^-4" l-H
,
I
.
I
.
3S.
d^CL
9i^
r?: jfi.
Breaking
off in the
^
following
manner
T
howeyer,
not,
would
be
g;ood
:
4--L
1^i^ "e.
39.
9.^
*^^ A"
Stationary
Upper of
or
the
atter, and
Sustained
tones
if chords
oices
them,
ith
gainst
not
foreign
Thus
pper
the
voice,
kind
this
belonging
such
since
only to
voices
do
which
is
chords,
determining
he
of
in their
caution
greater
require
are
not
to
the
possess to
the
very
appear
peculiar
ner man-
than
rare
the
treatment.
conform
them
more
much
in the
tone,
one
upon
stationary
described,
before
organ-point
Voices.
remaining
voices
middle
I
E
X_^
"-
""-
the
in
rarely
of
power
Bass
of
character
or
the
these
connection
counterweight lower
voice
a
one.
organ-point
will
of
Example
last
in the
No.
measures,
234
sound
a^
very
being
transposed
unpleasant
into
the
:
40.
while
hords
41.
JiE^^I^^^ the of
following the
example
tone,
as
prolonged
belong
to
it
:
dominant,
is better
because
the
las
As
example for their
ind
the
hile
treatment,
Mass
ubini's
icular
in
choir
o
taking
harmonic to
he
Stationary
re,
lways
appear
oiced
movement
A-major,
in
in
the
the
they
the
occur
In
rarely
I
t has
be as
as
he
occur
only
character
the
case
so
of
with
in
and
middle
throughout
of the
case
no
relations
which
is, however,
following
in
there
ninth,
; in
length,
great
"^
I
I
they
the
e.
four
g.
I
I
to
the
regarding
found,
also
they
to
viz., in
bear
ninth can
them
of
the
as
foreign no
into
together
a
with
chrrd
of
-""
rr ^^0
#-
Eg
sions inver-
inmiediato greater
chords, stationary
the
-I-
943.
at
it, as,
to
resolution. their
that
independent
connection
forms
regular
ninth,
occur
following
[in the reckoning]
brought
are
the
ninth,
with'
position
harmonies
certainly
which
the
of
included
he
chords
and
f^=^
^
voice
HI
s
"
chorda
inverted
an
That
for
the
of
said
objection
groimd
same
i
sevenths.
in the
the
with
KB.
I
fundamental
that
used
furnishes
the
A
the
"
stationary
is found
ninth
remarked
in the
above,
the
of
hoven' Beet-
of
compositions
^
was
if the
treated
. I
i
what
h^
Example
heen
already cannot
hey
in too
not
1"
of
be
circumstances
ffi"
^As completion still find place :
roximity,
the
n
chord
found,
upon
serves
and
instrumental
to
and
!
I
I
I
"
complete
violins
be
can
upper
par
Fahrt
Scherzo
the
in the
to
^
foregoing
the
gliickliche
throughout
voice,
are
voices
according
*
I
In
it their
of
chords
of
tone
lowest
in the
42.
ay
Trio
is based
stationary
P^
here
harmonic. the
voice.
upper
a.
Rkmark.
be
which
middle
strengthened
^
few
but
not
as
und
cases
reckoned
organ-point
tones
those
as
Meeresstiile
D
the
so
of time,
basis.
as
piece
be
just
;
Che-
of
length
a
below
out
"
Gloria
"
for
A]?
carry
part,
both
would
sometimes as
sometimes
whole
Tn
also
in
itself
shows
oices,
overture
tone
may
Symphony
hich
the
prolonged
this head
Under
"
in the
hold
violins
tones
prolonged
and
voices
adduced
progressions
Bartholdy.
the
which
be
can
place
instruments
and
Mendelssohn
f
stationary
the
introduction
n the
a
of
C-major, where
and
melodic
use
efTective
of
tan dis
since tone,
for example^
ninth.
g
MANUAL
128
If
we
by
mark
they
organ-point,
Bass,
to
wish
must
HARMONY
have the
cases
barmonio
tbe
numbers
always
in many
whereby
OF
to
reference
otherwise
progression the
in tbe
tone
stationary
the
of
marking
general
th"
abord
chords
s altered. Thus
the
fotmd
organ-point
J
9 ^ 5
=
No.
tmder
"
?
6
3b
4
4
I
234
h, could
'
7
%
be marked
8 4 2
6 4
4
thus
:
7
i
944.^
Such
ount
a
of
manner
scores
ustomary
of
soh,
Among
The
tones
the
be passing
and
or
foreign
harmony
filling out,
the
harmonic
by
voice-steps,
are
I
e.
of
tones
be given.
to
be reckoned
lying
betweeni
g.
*-2
J
1
g "
J-r-J
^gg^grjgEg
a*^
:z^(52
^
i
"-e"L
msn
t
X
can
itself is to
especially
means
\
\-A
-triad
otherwise
b.
45.
harmonic
the
with
Notes,
Changing
the
IS.
notes
the
with
organ-point
a.
The
find
often
that,
for which
notes.
through
smaller
to
we
ac*
Xiy.
Notes*
changing
first arise
f greater
e
the
CHAPTER
JPassing
its incompleteness,
indicates
which only
accompaniment,
organ
also
on
purposes,
especial
is introduced,
figuring
tasio
words
for
used
it and
reading a
where
the
organ-point
is only
marking
difficulty
the
in
eason,
of
marked
by
hy-tones^
be conceived,
a
cross
that #.
q.
X
form
is, in
so
the pass^ far
as
with
those
the
marked
first note
with
a
O
a
C
or
OF
UANUAL
129
EARMOHTT.
^ i=*
H9-
r
2.16.
(9-
i^
The
onic,
those
Th)B
note
onic
notes
they
;
it, upon
fter
hy
Changing
he
accented
ote
(No.
ented
247
the
at
iatura
or,
not
are
the
to
over
note
with
the
of
dior
called
chord,
but
introduced
be
can
and
har-
another
of the
entrance
measure,
the
the
manner
the
of
melodic
(thus in
of
this
the
mony har-
appog^
sense
upon
harmonic the
upon
like
two
the or
to
notes
passing
adornment
to
suspension
themselves
attach
and
a
harmony
of the
measure), the
of
character
entrance
foreign
tones
those
are
contrary,
in
after
for
serve
part,
the
of
a)^
the
of the
time
part
247
therefore,
appear
either
which
245
degrees.
on
notes,
harmonic
one
divisions
smaller
No.
Example
of
i
F
passes.
from
go
appear,
in progression
nly
a
under
b chromatic
under
passing
i
found
notes
passing
i
1
p
unao*
(No.
notes,
").
*^* ^^
i
"SHm The
changing
oined It
closely
can
otes
be
note,
The
he
he
ote,
as
to
of
peculiarity
whereby
he formation
be
well
as
from the
one
the
appoggiatura,
that
tones
arise,
like the
as
that
note,
a
minor
is to
following
be
chani^ing th^
if it enter
of the
part second seen
the
moni har-
above.
especially
accented
show.
helow
immediately
lies immediately
the
247
No.
examples,
lies
harmonic
form
in
6a
however
it must
skips,
examples
above
which
to
in
the
which
upon
it inclines
chromatic
the
note
the
helow
note an
by
as
note,
seen
by
formed
changing
manner
har^nonic
to the
is further
therefore appear
can
note
from
to
measure,
the
No.
be
after has
principal
247,
hence, :
J J
^
I
I
I
J-/ i J j I
I
f
I This
applies
It is otherwise the
n
if they
a
at
Those
only
will not
^^
^'^
.
Definite
une
as
notes
in the
hemselves
manner
of
the
ing series of chang-
""
at
the unaccented
No.
250, are
key
the
"*"
J
r
i ; it is also
as
note
changing
note,
formed
J
,U
whole can
step
in
to
they or
better the
at
appear
in respect
major
c{.
a
is right.
whether
form
as
the
"1^
unnecessary,
which note
250
good
^
determine
can
so
f
changing
always
and
^ J
find that
can
only
is not
c
part, require No.
Example
the
given
harmonic
they to
according
the
the
above
the
latter
stiecession
because
chord-tone
bears
triad
with
the
that
be
cannot
will certainly
the
of
Since
so
seventh,
gkips),or
he
third
octave.
Changing
ear
musical
^The
"
fifth and
head
this
as
take
they
f
J
,
rr
on
rules
every
Remark.
h
":
,
r
as
in
Thus,
^^^^^^
350.
so
be like b^ while
necessarily I
following
formed
fall upon
which
second.
minor
""
/iHoh
be
the
skipa
whereby
I
below,
notes
the
partially
ormation
Thus
notes.
r
changing
series,
progressing
necessity,
of
f
a
bj
introduced
notes
changing
in
passing
not,
would
the
appear
the
of
character
notes
to
particularly
than same
it.
free
enter
minor
diatonically,
seconds
and
(by
to
govern
modulation.
iJ^t^J^
mmi
^-fZZM^
51.
-j=;=ti^! We
he
often
chord
meet are
note
in which
figures,
with
use
made
of
one
after ^
^
^
^
^
notes
changing the
e.
other, ik
^
X
SDrSQ=,-M S
"
"
"
s^
I
below
and
g. ^
^
52. "
above
^^mM r
^
*
Upon
HARMONY.
OF
MANUAL
this is founded
following
also the
131
manner
occurriig
often
of
eni'
bellishment:
r Passing
y
and
preference,
ll the
ones,
and
rogression by
ere
also
lack Tho
this
of
the
be
can
voice
in
adapts
means
admit
proper
mean
clearness
following
this
one a
concerting
can
simply
of
more
character,
Wherever
the
introduction
significant
since, otherwise,
be the
by
case,
by-
such
position
of such
melodic
the
while
not
the
place,
in comparison
prominent
interchangeably,
be found,
must
this takes
If this should
significance.
it for
If
will become
prominent,
made
thereby
a
of
f
in all voices.
occur
receive
and
I
I
for accompaniment.
serve
gain
can
alone,
voice
others,
voices voices
ill
ow^
the
with
emaining
notes
changing in
1
fefe=#^ i^ii;^^
958.
by-tones,
development over
and it
; but
fullness
and
easily arise.
harmonic
movement,
54.
ight,
i jS"
LJJ. * I "
by the
use
i
r
of the above
by-tones,
assume
the following
form
:
=|^:z"z:tT=:^-+-^-Lrl
55.
-^--f-^s^a
isr.
U -"-
^=SEi
182
tn
m
"
r.
"p
2^ I
The
That
through
can
age
in
f it is executed to
dapted In
this
he
Jiarmonic
ote
J
the
tempo
can
the
with
in
another
if the
distance
which
occur
only
to
oreign
This
the
least
is at
harmony
reduplication,
will of a
take the
rapid
igures
formed
ollowing
oiced
;
above
pas*
example
is better
moTcment
slow
care
suspensions, is introduced
the
of
one
is to
be
taken,
ihai
no
voice
through
fundamental
a
as
was
receiver
changing
from
tone
tono
the
g.
I
I #"
-*"
1
"s-
the
of
fundamental
the
with
principles
in general
reduplication fifth, than
or
the
with
chord.
however,
movement,
through
; this
more
and notes,
changing
shows
passage
vocal
better
place
e,
4"1.
to
according
harmonic
octaye,
*'''i^
In
in the
the
g.
This
hird
a
harmony,
the
seen
notes,
changing
in connection tone
be
to
X-
crosses
writing.
of of
is to
rapid
by
marked foreign
tones
of
OTcrloading,
somewhat
manner
remarked
e,
a
introduction
the
efore
from
suffer
easily
use
copious
such
here
are
notes
changing
and
passing
to
be
extended other
sure,
cannot
carrying
considerations
be
out
of
arise,
conceived
of
as
such
as
a
the
four-
:
movement
I5".
\ In
the
case
pproximation
of the to
regular
harmonic
passing tones,
notes,
and
like regard
figures
such
is to as
No.
be had 259
to a^
theii
hf d"
".
a.
More
figures
rapid
this approximation
allow
more
""
g.
J_..
I
4.
e.
readily,
fi
la:
-^:
es Cg-^ttTfr^ :r-f.
-^n
i
-"-
60.
"
#
-I
"
"
"
I
-I
"
I
I
-0-F-[ I
'aulty
("
I
J "
in
Progressions
1
#-^-^
"
"
"
Connection
Passing
with
Changing
and
Notes*
it is the
Since
he
the
of
kips
change
harmonic of
examples,
Open
from
that
formed
will be
harmonic
with as
false
no
ones
the
as
ver
other
the
open
in the
hand, octayes,
and
with
in the
as
:
because
the
f^
instances,
following
will be
consequently
I
Bbxabk.
"
^The
the
passing
considered
notes as
will not
faulty
'
I
I
p=_^^
last kind
of ootaves
would
firs
I
"| r
863.
low fol
I
868.^^ S0 the
connection
arise,
occur,
cannot
in
movement
second.
J:
On
arise
the in
care
progressions
tones
passing much
take
mnst
fifths open
covered
octayes
them
f
we
fill out
to
notes
passing
progression,
harmony,
the
the
of
proyince
find application
in inatrumerUal
movemenitf
In
like
arallel
the
maimer
be
is to
movement
or
entrance
if it takes
faulty
called
the
of
progression
in the
place
ia
note
changing
following
:
anner
letUr 1
I
:
I
1
64.
^=fi?:
"-
"
3^
last
is
example
because
better
i
it
I
ii^fe^E^g The
i
ii.
^
the
octaye
appears
progression
overed.
P"issing
and
in
Notes
Changing
ime
moTcment
is best
ixths,
e.
the
of
passing
in parallel
adapted,
Voice
one
at
the
time*
same
The
than
more
in
notes
than
more
to
motion,
the
one
at
Toice
same
thirds
of
successions
the
and
g. I
I
^f-
^^T^S
w
65.
i
Jl
IS.
i
t
The
lso
free
produce
hich
require
isagreeable
parallel
Toices
are
only
the
with
in to
their
be
use
of
fifths, and
fourths,
seconds, caution
great effect
the
of
moTcment
treatment,
allowed
the
passing
seyenths,
and
on
in
and
singly^
of
account a
very
notes
all of
can
kinds, their
favorable
osition. Progressions
elow
in
fourths
are
good
if
a
third
is
voice
added
as
third
:
366.
Single
m=:*-s:S-t*^^=^z=^l
fiffch-successions
arising
from
passing
notes
are
occasionally
mei
OF
MANUAL
them
as
27
age
Just
faultless.
(See
what
follows).
and
harshness
the
so
favorable
hrough
ndeed,
In
through
to
i^e
the
position
independence
he
in too
nd
an
passage
of
but
the
at
of
coloring,
peculiar
voices,
voices
many
be
only
the
of
intervals
various
especial, the
can
alleyiated
throughout;
voices
etc.
movement,
the
leading
good
fifbh-sttccessiont
concerning
said
seventh-successions
and
movement
is
which
the
of
tempo,
contrary
that
185
HARMONY.
thej
the
not
must
too
appear
to
much
contribute
and
often
notes
passing
numerously
time.
same
67.
J:^rj3J
_4rri3U5^j *?="^^5^ "^ ^^
^
Here
also
it will be
harmonic
imply
re,
a
nd
found,
basis,
the
at
notes,
passing
collocation
whose
which,
outside
with
others,
form leading,
(passing)harmonic
new
those
than
milder
lying
structure
intimate,
most
those
that
are
be
cannot
more
of the as
i
natural
harmonically
accou
for.
A
judgment
rrived
In
case
at
the
into
taking
worth
time,
same
e.
of
such
can,
movements
consideration
their
character
progressions,
several
voices
harmonic
regular
of
tones
by
only
at
the
concerning
however,
and can
be
tempo.
receive
passing
g.
^^
68.
"*-"^4u"
In
all such
hange
o
form
of
the
their
Changing a*
In
harmony
the
progression notes
two
everything
places
can
voices
voices
are
the
upon
in
a
in various
voioeB
question,
position
regularly. occur
:
depends
:
which
whether allows
at
the
theoi
In
motion:
paraUd
r$q" Im
eon^ory
mo^iofi.*
k.
970.
32:
b"
In
^^r^e
Toioes
I
3:
i
:
"".|^^^i
In
C"
-"-
1
four
voices
:
^fe^ 372
"m^^ Bemark.
^The
"
with
fessioDS
It becomes
ent
of
the
above
can
examples
also
have
force
the
of
harmonie
proi
organ-point.
from
evident
a
these
in changing
natural,
produce
ronounce
the
of
voices
most
ppears
lways
two
most
very
disagreeable
notes
changing
notes,
the
the parallel
while
the
of
tliat also
examples,
eflfect.
fourths,
Thus sort,
the
in
progression
seconds,
following
in
one
no
good
parallel
thirdi^ and
fifths and ^ould
be
move*
sixths
sevenths
likely
:
good
-^^^^^pi
o
Changing which
74.
can
notes
they
are
also
joined, e,
:^="v g-f
be g.
of longer
duration,
than
the
harmonic
not
to
The
II.,
XIII.
their
immediate Since in
f
on
a
24
page
of
the our
be
As
harmonic
founded
re
he
passage, to
than
more
question
does
immediate
our
?
ing develop-
for
adapted
particularly
the
is
the
inner
bear
be
appropriately
will
be excluded
be
will always
;
necessity
easily
everything
; in
brie^
i
which
; but
used
anything
the essential
to
rather
fresh,
and
in
general,
:
far
so
introduction
unnatural
a
firstly
reckoned,
over-fullness,
produce
witness
originality
sure,
carrying
and
unessential.
unessential
no
recognition
be
to
then,
will
voices
They
and
spoken
:
manner
(Kunsteleien)in artificialities
harmonies.
sed
object of
only
structure),allow
work
embellishment,
the
upon
the
composition
ar^
formationsy
from to
means
was
consider
harmonic
immediate
the
for
separate
to
for
the pure
most
only
belonging
All
speak
voices.
develop
to
lse, serving
ust
the
"
th
"
in this
means
these
harmonic
simple
these
in
that
adorning
dapted
to
still to
structure
necessary
it something
exercises
If, however, of
have
structure
harmonic
pure
becomes
present
It is undeniable
ut
it
way, to
{the
and
harmonic
pure
"
term
the
application
urpose^
the
We
investigatio
careful
materially
contributes
structure.
a
studies.
and
What
to
relation
general
arrowly,
them
of
to
them
subject
in Chapters
explained
subjects
to
enough
harmonic
inner
the
of
nderstanding
of the
knowledge
thorough
a
oncerning
is great
XIV.,
and
as
;
r
in composition,
significance,
free, powerfully
o
tion, condi-
weak
mentally
movement
secure
little
of
over-loading
swollen or
morbid
they
as
;
Then: Irregular
oices,
introduction
and
however
Especially, The
from
ood
in
;
short,
music
founded,
excluded,
and
good
in
ovements
purpose,
erve
not
then
this
the
also
merely
free
tones
stationary
of
;
the
and
figuresformed
inappropriate
appears
which
is received in
much
in the
leading
pure
struck
composition
for practice
also
are
which
is appropriate
which
after-struck
use
to
a
there" simple,
song.
fact, vocal
is
and
everything
four-voiced
the
suspensions;
:
notes
changing
If, in
If
the anticipated
of
the
of
manner
will
not
of
to use
chorals
exclude
for embellishment
the
but
the
elaboration
of
al
which
itself remain
will of
and
is directly use
upon
compositions.
harmonies,
the
voices,
it
with
instrumental of
the
of
connection
basis
the
as
of
suggested
those
for the
for
means
development
learning
the
chorals as
in
or
simple to
most
so
of
far
o
as
the
the
they
lead*
Among
he
passing
regular
In accordance
abors
o
in
use
be
The
of
study of
all
for attempts
our
of
forbids to
not
the
good
compositions far
we
the
fter
called
manner
hord-formations, is
nner
the
in
this
contrapuntal
immaterial,
for
serre
as
and
the
complete
XIX;
Chapter
subject,will
like"
practice
in
afford
Part
nity opportu-
Xy.
Chords.
chords,
entrance
found
in
which in
notes
passing
the
sometimes
the
struo-
own.
passing
of
later
purpose,
discussed. to
return
JPassing
are
of
and
harmonic
pure
things
will
CHAPTER
Those
snsponsions
and
many
object.
thus
of the
harmony,
of
study
as
subjects
of the
use
strictness
chief
in which
book,
this
of
the
the
which
places,
from
thorough
nderstanding
II
judged,
appropriate
deviation
ausing
first
the
with
now
may
the foregoing,
with
the
notes.
changing
and
in connection
ure
to be reckoned
is especially
these
and
from
of
the
measures,
of
as
appear
voices,
several
treatment
deviating
parts
smaller
which,
chord-
of
rules
general
actual
however,
onnection.
Of
these, in three
otes
ust
n
a
the
so,
certain
There
ere
most
the
of
be
sense
already
in
chord
form,
the
on
which
chords
called
however,
are,
take
as
voices,
appeared
passing
are
such e.
passing g., in Nos.
formed
over
an
changing
and
271
272.
and
can
organ-point
chords.
still other
phenomena
of
kind,
the
be
to
are
which
explained. in
As,
to
It is known,
in
that upon
rests
a
cast
the
becomes
necessary the
at
glance the
notes
changing
and it
measure,
of chords
assing
passing
general,
elations
ccent
has
kind
one
various
even
simple,
depend for
the
division
varieties
first measural-division,
explanation of
of
while
upon
principally
the
measure.
the
measure^
the
of
the
second
natural
receives
ess weight. If
now
ivisions,
then
(Thesis) will
onceived
harmonic
the
of
the
always as
the
be based
progression harmonies, appear
goal
to
which as
whitsh
the the
come more
chords
simply
upon
the two
upon
the
accented
weighty, of
the
and second
must
measuraldivision always
divison
be
(Arsis
^^
d
:5t -"-
KT
75.
f
In
this
oes
not
That
een
sense,
this has
he
following
in the
so
by
this
movement
be called
can
measural-diyision
fact
the
that,
the
character
theirs
of
to
assigned
not
more
in
\ and
divisions
the
more
of
those
of
to
conceded
the
plainly has
care
case
however,
appears,
smaller
if seldom
eyen
entrance,
thesis was
which chords
passing
theory,
their
at
upon
allowed
the are
in the
understood
been
of as
second
regular
the chords
has
harmonies
uch
of the
plainly.
been
character
t
.1^
chords
upon
arsis, much
SL
4:
although
is shown
bestowed
The
the
so
appear
xpressed,
:^
:ozzi"!:
chords,
assing
I
^=1:
^E]
he
N^
i:^
-1-
ever
upon
former.
plainly measure,
with as
in
:
examples
76.
i IZ.
a.
2rr.
I
fcrt
I
=!^=^ :g
^
^
rf
I
=g:
"^
a
"-#-
'JUL
p=t The
peculiar
n Example
No.
manner
276
of a
and
appearance Cy
as
well
of as
the of
chord the
of
chord
the of
sixth the
and
seventh
fourth in c^
the
f
hord
passing the
of
These
if
ass
of No.
both
f
one
voice
277
a,
leading
The
If
be
can
voices
assing,
in the
thesis
(the
can
all chords
hord
to
allowed
nearest
(See has
a,
theii* for
stationary,
6.
276
in
recognized
remain
voices
in No.
voices
theii
goal
the
"
No.
above,
arisen
a9
character
the
example,
277).
from
the
application
modes.
this condition
hen
easily
upper
to
degrees^
measure.
more
still
the
the
of
following
is
or
by
voices^
notes) of oM
free
enter
immediately
which
by
voices
degrees) is in the
will find explanation
they
;
the
of
progression
fulfilled
principal
them.
succeeds
7".
flEMARK.
the first
he
its
also
uneven
simple
of the
explanation
finds
before,
ntioned
In
^In this
"
varieties
Passing
free treatment
the
chords,
of the
seventh,
justification.(See NB.)
measural-division,
ess weight.
passing
they
whereas
chords
will
the
measure
of
two
contain
falls upon
following
manner
79. ft
6
2
7
6
5k
I
I*
8
9
7
4
2 8
J8^ 7 JB-T
6 5
6
g :F=1
Smaller
bove,
can
measural-divisions
no
is needed
example
arieties
of
Here
also
o
4
R
ft
ot
measural-divisions
in the
themselves
show
likewise
accent
also
it, and
for
chords,
passing
contain
just
little for
as
the
the
after
and
compound
measure.
the
study
of
good
compositions
be explanatory,
will
lead
and
advancement.
For
personal
All
chords
nown
irst
rules case,
attempts
designated of
which
the is
the as
following
passing
connection more
frequent,
of
wA\
harmony, no
may
remarks
farther
progress
either or
still find place
deviate
remark
according
from
is necessary
them.
:
to
tho
In
the
; in the
last,
lelvcs, as
o be
nto
hy
voices
assing
It
correct.
called
the
of
in relation
also
the
account
tha,t all such tempo
rjthm,
here
also
will
in
be remarked
only
character
The
term
There
the
to
treat
The
art
e
tand
Every
the
of
modulation
Firstly
It
be
:
oal,
and
take
In
the
first
allow
a
in
correctly
;
now
we
modulation.
finding
keys,
XI.
in
harmonies
those
out
by
order,
which
of these
means
to
other.
be
in various
effected
it to
t is commonly
more
ways,
and
it
for
a
length
it will
case
attain
to
impress
of
serve
will
various
key
upon
5y,
pass
the
out
seek
or
key
new
as
a
basis. the
the
out
worked
new
as
key,
new
and
ear,
by
its ap*
make perhaps,
in the
of itself;
gradually the
means,
simplest
development
definite
the
for^
leave
soon
and
time
itself
avail
but a
of
and
completed
prepared
gradually
prepared to
be quickly
abruptly^
decision,
with
ndeavoring
the
taking
after
in Chapter
modulation
effecting
more
or
the
can.
begin
:
for
two
judged
of
composition.
explained
each
consists
can
modulation
Secondly
earance
into
been
already
means
with
key
one
urposes.
ot
best
of
character
Modulation.
for
determine
to
was
object
in connection from
ass
has
modulation
the
are
XYI.
Means
the
be
to
of
CHAPTER On
the
are
this kind
of
that the progression
general,
determine
passages
and
formations
whether
other,
each
can
degrees and
chords^
to
various
will probably
indeed
second
case
means,
and
also
lead
tO
close.
Thus,
in the
following
example;
I i
"
J" J-^-
80.
he
6
0:
modulation
F:
Vi
will be
transient
and
frequently
charging,
without
forsaking
kind
This
and
of
must
prevail,
In
the
which
is
if they
to
are
not
its place
t"kes
nearest
by
reached natural
appear
especial
decided
and
organic
and
keys^
related
combinations
unintelligible.
the
; the
reached
gradually
be
very
however,
example,
for the
adapted
can
ones
development
next
one
new
only
their
still in
meanS}
distant
more
although
is
modulation
distant
more
key
original
key
becomes
is entirely
the
forsaken,
goal,
the
and
:
i^sfe*
Ml.
I
This
example
for itself to
order
shows
the
new
it, and
reach
how
plainly,
key
V7
Eb:
B[": vno^Bbrl
as
the
use
such
the
of
it
as
rather,
modulation,
extended
use
makes
goal,
this
the
was
the
i
modulation,
passing
not
seta
which
to
object
"b
reach
major quickly. Unless
we
compositions
in
doctrine
Remark.
We
An
"
der
use
at
attention
the will
for
means
be
first and
The
to
may
of
the
promote
is
arrangement immediate
our
be
Analyse.^^
"
skil^
in
of
the
the
of
the
modulation
"
author's
(Leipsic,G.
formation
part
of
of
purpose.
in the
found
i
of
modula*
formation
the
of
use
the
important
an
two
"
Orund*
Die
Wigand.) as
modulations
such use
work
of
the
harmonies
exer*
and
connection.
for both
erve
to
the
ihre
und
present
thereby
appropriate
While
this
of
Formen
musikalischen
make
foreign
elucidation
cises, in order
their
is thus
however,
made of
the
time,
same
be
must
formation
the
upon
the
This, to
they
exercises,
at
part,
belongs
and
and
as
between
interlude
as
passages
since
divisions.
of Form,
composition,
in
rests,
their
and
or
manner,
special
themselves
periods
zuge
a
short
keys,
different
of
composition
tions
to
wish
to
paid
the
hind
designated
above
means
simplest THE
the
TOiaC
being
are
modulation
of
searched
out,
used,
since
modulation
immediate
no
the
same
lirst
key,
then
harmony
o
can
kinds.
will be OF
TRIAD
THE
NEW
KEY
itself.
If, however,
what
succeeds
this triad
is already
only,
particularly
and
a
component
the
part
subsequent
of
the
dominant
OF
MANUAL
ollowing
ey
example
G-major
of
a^
at
no
felt, while
to
come
we
when
148
will be
modulation
only
plainly
HARMONY.
the
h
at
harmony
third
hear
we
the
:
b.
":
In
case
riad, have
a
ncline
to
decided
more
harmony
itself
TTi^
the
triad
minor
effect, still for the it
succeed
will
make
keys
distant
more
of
I
":
-O-
"
^=*^
(at a)
as
tonio
the
inant dom-
howeyer,
triadj
major
dominant
as
understood
f the
sure,
definiteness
of
sake
be
to
can,
will
(")"
a.
us:
1
":
i
?^
83.
jSZ
*
O-
6 5
6 5
I
3C 0:
I
C:
I
f:
I
m
I
b:
1^
i
a:
2:
t="="^
-^-
3r
6
6 3-
I
V
G:
:q:
0:
I
As
n
way
used the
of
(see
eeling
hords,
ollowed
84.
of
a
but
by
For 49
pages
modulation, enters
the
at
the
dominant,
V
k:
triad
great
fourth)
and
sixth
I
as
1
df?:
tonic
in
above,
decided.
articularly
adence
the
as
unsatisfying
the
hord
a:
t
which
quality
as
53),
so
if it is not thesis.
degree
it
just and
the
itself to
shows
has of
naturally it
used
However,
one
takes
the
the
part at
manner
case
modulation,
inversions
such
rendering
in this
first completes
its
of
produces in
be, for
in
its
modulation the
entrance
of
(th
the
closing the
passing
also, it is naturally
modulation.
Upon
arsis it will
the
indicate
not
f:
ft.
6 4
All
f
7b
triad,
(which
as
the
most
natnral to
best
the
comprehended,
hord
of
the
from
seventh,
keys
of
From
emain
a
more
still
meaiif
potent
the
C-major for
undetermined
From
C
to
chord
in the
the
is
shows
it
through
since,
key
seventh) the
the
of
reach
following
major
all keys,
F:
"
into
and
E!^, E
except
major C
or
the
keys,
augmented
Fj|,(itcan
and
thus
minor) G:
"
dominant
remaining
of
be
stationary
the
all
that
will
or
through
triad
whether
present
like
through
third,
harmooy
of
effected
can
manner.
connection
be
dominant
the
of
seventh
effected
major
C
d:
ihat
tonic
can
the
of
and
we
harmony
can
the
minor
dominant,
the
of
digression,
of
chord
which
(preparation),modulations
ourth.
to
seventh
means
that
principle
ones
the
I
:
intermediate the
the
dominant
the
through
to
easily
xcept
6 4
7
i
point
of
chord
determined
without
According
ost
I
6 4
HARMONY.
and
especially
modnlation
e effected
the
as
nnmistakably
The
however,
DOMINANT
well
applies
s most
^1
2t
r
vix^ THE
as
"
"
abore,
given
modulation,
tself
:
^
examples
The
55=g
s.
T
(i
definitely
so
^
m
"
(p
key
the
O
:
a:
"
86
w "*"
0
0
B:
"
0
Db:
"
"p#^^^f^ C
^^
Ab:
"
'^
^tlS
1
A
Bb:
-
fe^^ '=*^=* Everywhere
ach
other '
:
thus,
in these
by from
a
tie,
C
the
examples the
mediate
major
to
D
like
transition
minor,
the
tones, to tones
which the
G
are
dominant
and
E,
connected of
which
the
next
become
It only
Rexabe."
through
other
be
need of
positions
that
mentioned,
the
e,
chords,
O
these
be
alBO
reached
g,
o:
"
modulationv
or: ^^^
If
re
we
to
wish
tion
e,
by
manner,
simplest
it
above,
wanting
in
modulate
the done
be
can
by
means
of
then
triad), which
a
into
manner
same
inserted
an
keys
the three
the
supplies
(in the
chord
conneo-
missing
g, "^om
0
Bb:
to
0
f
988.
"g"
c
O
E:
"
FJ:
"
pb^jftei
"
"
^f^^
WB "-
The
which
from
modulation From
to
"
the
A
b:
can
minor
be formed A
d:
"
thus
:
x:
"
fr
F:
"
289.
-^=^"^
he
G:
"
"*"
Bfe:
-
":2." 2.
I To
hord
^-
i^^ife TT
the
C, D|?, E[?,F||and
keys
remaining
At^,by
means
of
a
connecting
: From
G:
to
"
"
Db: Db:
" -
"
"|^:
"
|E^p^HH^^^=pe^^ I*
-T-
"
-r-
n:
i^^^^^^^E It is self evident simplest
principle^ always
should
odulations
that
of harmony ;
as,
this that
and take can
place
manner
it is by
no
without
the following
is only
modulation
in this way
be produced
for example,
of
means
; likewise, a
that
as
tone,
stationary
modulations
that
necessary
can
as
exhibited a
modulation
simple so
also
connecti
can
be accomplished
From
0
G
E^:
to
"
s:
"
0:
"
391.
""-^^^^^^^^^^^
for
the
Ter,
connection
be
always
this principle,
these
ake
This
til
of
to
and
the
means
chord
for
ince
its
evepth
nter
CHORD
the
at
following Prom
ature,
The
to
this
following
takes
as
and
to
also
piano-forte.
in
the
use
o
of
the
the
seventh
bilit capa-
of
SEVENTH.
the
in
dominant
the
than
modulation
particularly
dominant
the
of
place
for
adapted milder,
those
harmony
latter,
the in
cases
be
would
har-
which
to
obliged
time.
same
C
B};:
of
B:
O
chord
shows,
"
this
use
this
d:
"
by
:
chord
a
means
k:
"
its
of
enharmonic
capability.
peculiar chords,
the
present
application,
farther,
a
chord
DIMmiSHED
cases
more
much
examples
0
Beside
be
is
THE
most
fundamental
and
The
dexterity
further
greatly
the
upon
with
all keys,
positions,
yarious
performance
dominant
the
OF
in
which
entrance
tree
modulations most
by
us
acquainted from
via.,
frequently
will
the
will
with
shares
modulation,
chord,
QOny,
to
proceeding
THE
This
into
evident
thoroughly
it will, how-
composition.
of
Another
down
keys,
the
of
ourselves
write
chords
connections
mechanical
make
to
this end
especially
and
to
use
great
bring
to
therewith
harmonies
of
entirely
like
to
as
but
sound,
variously
written
:
m.^^t^S=S Jong
to
ik^^ second
different
four D
to
minor,
keys, in
the
viz.
:
third
in to
first form
the B
in
minor,
F
to
the
minor,
fourth
to
in
At^
nor.
U^hrough From
Since
now
this G
to
C
f:
all the
ohords
fourfold
a
circumstance
"
of
d:
the
is possible
modulation 0
diminished
"
o
b:
seventh
can
:
"
appear
^x
in
ih"
=1^ ^^^^^l="z=jj
395.
nd
eaoh
eys,
them,
of
enharmonic
present
themselves
for
all
the
twelve
in
modulations in many
hich
be
ften
Here
instead
of
Although uses
e used
too
writing
as
manner
often,
in as
well
of
the
of
modulation
harmonic
of
fold mani-
it should
that
its artistic
connect
to
adapted
remarked
inner
the
of
itself to be
lightly,
applied
manner
multiplicity
be
can
major.
this
shows
t
minor,
this chord
comprehension
still it must
being
since,
of
in
since
major, in
of
the
modulation
composition,
actual
down
keys
four
to
belong
will
twelve
harmony
dominant
advancement
keys,
all
this in
add
the
of
to
greatly
onnection
can
industrious
the
also
tend
ill
we
cases
used
interchange,
through
not
becomes
worth
ess. A
similar
in
not
so
a
comprehensive
i
manner,
by
xhibited
THE
Its
though
application,
as
similarity*
regards
THE
OF
CHORD
AUGMENTED
to
sound,
the
SIXTH
AND
dominant
FIFTH.
chord
of
the
seventh
996.^1^^^
ith
enharmonic into
certain
From
O
Viy
C:
Although,
uickly
to
of
ollowing
keys,
B.
one
From
C
into
the
other,
a
were
modulation
still
be
d:
sought
(since it
quickly c^
exercises
d:
"
EfesViy
I
means
the
skill
V
I
the
out
carry
and
out
with
will
V
i
iiOiy
not
i
which
always
decidedly),for
extended
and
given
out
to
be the in
pass
the
ther fur-
the
:
key to
g"
above,
key
latter, for modulati
the
with
"Eq
iiOiy
one
manner
From
e.
b:
in the
from
ntention
to
it, in connection
adapts
change,
D
into
through
298.
the
other
by
triad
the
means
of
of the
third
fej^-ir^ _
the triads degree
of :
various
degreeg
Cf IKs/ourth
d"ffrs6
Of
degree:
Qflhejt/th
:
the
dsgree
aieUh
"
99.
|jgr"^ (Jfthe
1=1^ ":
"
degree
seventh
"
S-"
m
(s^
1* From
C
the
0/
E
to
major
tliroagh degree
second
triad
the
the
Of
:
degree
fourth
degree:
Qfiheffth
:
I (A"
(y
degree
"iMA
Of
:
the
degree
eenenXh
:
$ pt^iSEt^l^ indications
These
to
ccording
the
Extension
suffice
may
same
m learning
to
and
its
Completion
form
other/
modulations
principles. Modulation
of
for
through
the
Cadence.
The
process
based
s
If
the
ormulae To
a
G
to
e
form
be solved
^i "
0
!l^
t
"
from
they
mentioned
the
C
not
in the
following
major
a
"
^ .f
something
the
other,
through
in this
manner
key,
of the
best
applied
i
cadence-
manner.
of problems, d
the
modulation
use
kind
new
however
passing
The
key
ultimate
into
are
gradually.
for ourselves made
301.
l-"
only the
digression
this end,
before
into
minor,
minor.
would
problem
the
establish
be
modulation
major
This
can
we
end
but
introduced
key
new
to
a
key
one
means.
natural
length
at
serve
sure,
will, however,
this
Let
be
from
passing
most
and more
out
directly,
and
and
simplest
to
for
above,
carry
must,
suddenly
nd
to
wish
means
sed,
the
upon
we
bove
shown
:
a
e.
g.
minor,
In connection
the
the
f
takes
modulation
tonic
triad
dominant
he
is to
following
the
cadence,
its
e,
the
of
chord
143), then
page
sixth
the
be
will
progression
natural
bo
fourth
and
succession
of
sufficient
for
g.
I
303.
the
(see
key
new
with
cadence,
through
place
the
of
chord
the
ffecting
^1
": "^
In
e
the
cases
other
of
40)
closing
such
in
formulae
determine
to
order
following
the
4.
I
""
4-
final
the
key.
other
"=^
will
the
:
:
poHUone
I
la:
i^
"1-
As
used
i^^^
i
3!:
formulaB
closing
ajre commonly In
a.
i
known
the
or
cadence^
extended
(see page
requisite
implest
"=g: --gr
03.
o
the
of
addition
:
bserved If
the
with
6
%
6
6
^dS^:
'-^
-"-
b.
*
f
^3
S
:s:
S 6 6 -(9-
?C
I
:2s:
In
other
:
poHtione
WE
^^
33?:
:2^
-o-
=# 6 6
If
6 6
g
m
these
the
may
be
of
shown
The
modulation
oprano.
To
this
m
be
3adence'formulaB
position
This
is: t
the
"
r*=t
"
last chord,
then
in connection from
C
is added
to
to
added
the
itself,
modulation
according
it is completed.
with
E{?,
the
i
No.
cadence
former
some
288,
closes
in the
examples.
with
position
the
which
fifth answers
in
the
to
From
I
Cadence
Oio'E^i
I
^^^^^^
e:
304. b
^gE^
6
6b
5^ 3^
-"-
^
=F The
following
to
O
to
A
in
a
"
J"
t
I
M-
286,
would
.fit
1"-
I
3
6
-"-
T
l^^i
i
-6?-
C
from From
require
i^
""-
f
305.
modulation
No.
Oadenee:
;
i
The
"^--
:
From
i
G
from
modulation
in this position
adence
^
X
-^
O
to
to
B
of the
use
with
t
cadence
under
No.
303
h
Cadence:
B:
306.
307.
^t 3
6
i^^^^^S To
close, From
we
present
Gh through
z
an
example
minor,
i
w=^
C
of
major,
a
and
more
extended
b{^minor -I
problem
A[^ major.
to
:
Cadence:
1-
wm^^m t^
fc^t^irfe These
indications
will be
sufficient
to
enable
us
to
form
for
ourselves
Through
hints
following
the
of the harmonies,
n the
use
me
time,
more
still
individual
this end,
the principles
cases
the
furnish
It
Harmonic
Simply
first be
may
be
will
voice its
purpose
will be, at
and
the
complete.
made
for farther
opportunity
Accampanim^ent
here,
that
remarked,
discussed
; all
and
rytlunical
metrical
developed
now
the
remarks.
XVII.
CHAPTER
The
to
most
extended,
explained, will
manner
until
EXERCISES
STRUCTURE.
HARMONIC
respecting
exactly
THE
HARMONIES."
PURE
THE
IN
USE
THEIR
IN
THE
OP
APPLICATION
RACTICAL
o
III.
PART
other
to
only
simply
elements
melodic a
of
development,
progression as,
melody,
be
will
Voice.
Given
a
for
o
for example,
the
present
"*
xcluded. 1. Harmonic
We
to
(Accompaniment
the
select
following
simple
a
Soprano,
exercise
:
3r
m
^
309.
P To
facilitate
the
foundation,
iarmonic
those
work,
be
will
fundamental
added
in the
tones,
which
maimer
used
can
serve
as
the
before.
o
$
310
-fli
js:
s-
.a.
i
**
11
With
every
mportant
We
turn
harmonic
progression^
the leading
of
the Bass
is the
most
point. our
attention
therefore
first to this, and
write
its
progression,
o
W: 6
6
"
a:
in the
r
following
:
way
6 4
6
T=25:
313
The
"
the
of
addition
"9-
is:
J.
.il
middle
will
O
O
now
O
G
D
2s=r
I
m
s
Aiao.
difficulties
no
present
a
^ 1!^-
BOPAAKa
I
2s:
Toices
O
313.
2E
3::(fe Tbnob.
6
6
3=1
m:
BaS8.
^
Let
S-i
this working of
The
he
n
G
D
the
next
a
of far
so
Examples
the
in
a
of
Bass,
the
of
harmonic
simplest
indication
with
for the explanation
present,
faulty the
0
as
well
can
fundamentals
acquainted
as
of
melodic
best
serve
:
o
0
IS-
la.
^ RncABK."
rin
lef for the
ersonal
ation
sake
work
used
of
saving
of the
in No.
of this
treatment
the
813.
pupil,
room,
however,
and we
and
the
write
the
voices
this end.
ix
314.
with
requires.
progression
manner
o.
becoming
for
opportunity
give
leading
out
worked
Exercise
will
good
as
for the
serve,
exercise
themselves.
exercises
general
of the
out
exercises
principles
G
following voices
recommend,
examples
together most
on
earnestly,
we
two
the
i use
the violin
staves
; for
manner
of
the
no*
OF
MANUAL
m
158
HARMONY.
^
-G-
" -"-
315.
^
"a -fi-"-
There
appears
rogression
he
ass
y
the
of which
The
the
use
Of
the
First,
ormer
us
its
any
on
account
still,
rejected
o
rule
ot
entirely.
harmonic
leading
continuity
is conditioned
by
for
compensated
the
has
the
contains
to
opportunity
this peculiar
of
and
Chord
the
its
chord
decided
a
the
of
progress
is farther
fourth
and
sixth
concern
necessary
difi"cult chord.
of
in
reason
the
of
what
add
Sixth
the
inversion
second
it oftenest
of
Fourth.
and
the
triad,
the
chord
its appearance
this, that
of
depends
th
upon
in
it appears
connection
like
character
vnth
the
formations,
cadence
as
a
in
connection
modulation,
with
143).
page can
in
show.
examples
also
probably as
not
egarded
Except
in
a
a.
If
the
fourth
b*
If
the
Bass
chord,
but
it appears
cases,
triad,
in both
free
enter
passing
these
ub-dominant
16.
or
be
good
if
only
tone,
a
also
of
find
we
Then,
The
a
and
of
voices.
Use
use
it is to
organ-pointy
of
give of
far known,
Bass,
stationary
transgression
a
conditions.
ertain
emains
the
example
fourth,
and
of
other
may
rare
ixth
It
the
previous
wice,
See
case
6
example
thus
powerless
preparation
necessary
The
and
it to remain
allows
4
chord-connection
stiff, uncertain, in
6
4
in this
nowhere
and
Except
6
under
the
progresses
always most
following
is prepared
cases,
it must
appear
naturally conditions
examples
show
be
the thesis.
tonic^
dominant,
or
:
;
by
degrees
to the
stationary
following
upon as
however,
then,
the
application
:
following
new
chord,
or
=m^i=s r^n 6 4
I In
Examples
the
dominant
onio,
feeling
the
roduces
Used
lso
and
the
upon
with
appear
i
-"-
t
it appears
a^
at
6 6
a
arsis
because
natorallj,
while
sub-dominant, of
most
degrees
other
upon
it rests
(")
upon
it easily
modulation.
(beside appearing
preparation
of
under
it
the above
conditions),
can
the Bass.
817.
The
ither
chord as
passing
uspension
the
fourth
and
sixth
(upon
chord
upon
t appears
the
of
thesis
;
the
shows or,
arsis),
as
preparation
with
itself in above,
in the
examples,
of the
character
Bass
the
of
all these
upon
the
thesis,
weaker.
much
i
S
^
t^E^.
"
p
r
1 "
rS
fP
31".
SEE
^
I
'JZ. I
\
-C-
6 4
Not
unfrequently
it
the
fourth
of
reparation
will
6 4
4 3
appear
is perfectly
%^-=^ ^^"^
"rt*-
819.
r "!
f
"O". "
"-
as
itself
a
6
suspension,
whereby
justified.
^y^S3 f^^"^=^
i
the
In
the
case
second
ccurring
(that of
chord
That
the
onnection
ivisions,
in passing,
however,
fourth,
and
by
it
because
arises
a
witli
rarely
degree).
third
sixth
leading,
a
with
the
the
of
chord
decidedly,
more
still
degrees,
the
of
can
smaller
of
voices
free
enter
also
in
measurat
:
as
^M^TEt^^^ ..7
-9-^
m^^
ill
chords,
passing
Remark.
ixth
and
In
the
farther
no
require
he
6
6 4-
-"H
E"
6 4
330.
The
"
often
has
fourth,
6), it is introduced
Decessary
led
introduction
the
after
to this
the
among
and
consonances;
XY.,
o
chord
of
the
dissonances.
the
division
of
(page 20) the
also
in the
fourth
perfect
in the
harmony,
of
system
in Chapter
279.
276,
it among
to reckon
theorists
many
the
of
m.
said
Nos.
examples,
preparation
was
what
after
explanation
and
I
intervals
the
reason
(page
this view
of
i
ven.
doubtful
The
nly
nd
over
only,
With
just as the
any
the
of its pre]i*ration
necessity in
and,
sixth, fourth
; between
is not
this
sixth
the
below,
above,
appear
the
for
e appropriate
voice,
the
of
the
and
fact, in
third,
and
other
the
the
voices
chor4
of
itself, tbi*
occurs
the
sixth
necessity
o
5mrth
is to be
chftra^ter
where, every-
perfect
consonance.
other
of
lowest
chord found
always
they
chord
in the
fourth,
perfect the
or
dissonances
real
whether
The
since
is not
reparation
the
of
the Bass,
against
fourth
reated
relation
four-voiced,
use
in the
or
fourth
and
for these
case,
of
fei
their
middle.
diminished
the
because
retain
it appears
triad
will fioldom
incompletes
too
^
E^:
:a. I
331.
6 4
6
1
"9-
On
the
ften
takes
oiced
place
of
the
occur
chord
in of
three-voiced the
second.
composition,
(See
later,
where the
i
thr"ie-
movement).
Besides
tself
the
it will
hand,
other
the
should
equirement
condition form
is,
a
of
good
a
good and
harmonic
progression,
intelligible
foundation
viz., that for
it, the
the Bt seooi
"
AmoDg
the
ertain
nnmelodio
have
progressions
beei
always
**iglitlj reckoned
skips.
The
g;^
22.
These
fourths
two
of
succession
improyed
are
fifths in the
thus
direction,
same
m
m
--"-
skips
and
e,
g.
i
izs: -"-
: x^
glzz
23.
^
"--
i
-O-
e: -"-
Even it,
f
better
are
a
of
skips
if the
sixth,
by
out
carried
situation skips
and a.
of
the
compass
of
in
contrary
third
a
hetUr,
admits
voices movement:
hetUr: JQ.
i
24.
I
IE
i
:a:
Augmented
interval-steps
iminished
however,
are,
as
avoided
unmehdic
good. better:
not:
S'-r"
25.
to be
are
skips
and
better:
not:
fe
"-
"
* better:
H"4:
Deviations
of
The
hole.
""
from
formation
this
are
rule
in the
or
melody,
often
the
of
observance
found
especial
rule
; they
character
in
find their of the
i
explanation as
composition
labors
theoretical
w
1:^^
It
be
always
will
improving.
ery
The
he
^
"^
9"
better:
nci:
into
skip
seventh
minor
me
the can
major
be
is to he
seventh
but
used,
only
in
case
of
inversion
an
into
that
avoided;
entirely
of
the
chord. not:
not:
jG
gjr
M.
-tsa..
I
~
-O-
-l?a.
^ff
-ST
-"il-
The
last, perhaps,
with
the
following not
izrrfc
^
-"
very
of
progression good
:
not
:
not
:
:
"
1
*
-"-
27.
harmony
6
"
t2"2-
ils: .ba-
ell
few
These
leading
elodic
alone
given
under
for
especially
and
It
the
still be
Bass,
the
of
a
of
good
(simply harmonic)
next
should
leading
for the
features
principal
sufficient.
not
apply,
rules
voices,
themselves
prove
xercises,
hese
of the
the
contain
observations
that
remarked, in
but
general
for
progression
of
ll voices. The
exercise
Bass,
he
be
out
worked
314
No.
can,
in this
something
iraproved
an
with
:
manner
fe^J^
i
""
"^^-
-"-
328.
8
6
i!ES
-js:
7 SSE.
m
i
EQC"rci8e80 1. JQ-
-p-
:sr.
b.
28
Jt^EEJ^S
"jf^
P
OOO
FOGG
"
O
F
"
8. "!5-
-"-
ISi
.Q-
:sr
-"-
fi__J._fi
^
_"5
I
W Qt
0
G
O
^7
"
Oiy
D
O
"i
4. r-^
-fi-
"3^ 6.
The
ant
-""r-"-
%-o
next
and
example
o.
"
will
give
of
harmonic
difficult part
m^: G
Di^
for
occasion
the
connection
s
and
"
of
explanation leading
of
O
Qtj
Di^
impor"
an
voices.
Exercise. C
bO
329.
The
^
A
\^
-O-
-"2-
following
faulty
work
serve
may
for illustration
bo
(
G^
D^
n^
-^
"ffi -^
i-^
^-
--0-
QtPj
O
1-"-
"
ps--^'^
830.
:
.2-
1
^
I
158
The
faults
doubling
the
of
occasion,
third
and
last
measure.
only
second
chord
through
fifth
covered
the
of
seventh
place
an
which,
awkward
a
skip,
with
the
in
J
the
out with-
position;
to the fifth
the
measure) to
next
dominant
the
seventh
(prepared). (See
present
already
Bass,
the
fourth
by
firstly, in
consist,
harmony
(from the
take
can
being
exercise
the following
and
last, this
fundamental
the
the
of
introduction
the
concerns
"
this
indicated
lastly, in the
As
the
of
to
gives
in the
secondly,
treatment
this
of
page
70)
i
I
"-
"
#
i
5";
331.
(
i
'JS. -"-
t=F More
he
tolerable
fundamental
and
in contrary
n
however,
motion^
connection
with
irst example
revious
of
chord,
it is either
333,
the
to be
favorable
seventh,
rejected entirely,
(G)
or
and
of
is already
applied
only
if, perhaps,
progressions,
fundamental
in another
although
the
of
""-
especially
No.
free entrance
;
moHon
'^"$
n parallel
is the
less harsh
in the
as
in
present
the
voice. ^-
p
333.
first of
The
he
-^
faults
the
is
second
I
-"
instanced
important,
more
will be
above and
.O-
will
is:
us
give
follows.
in what
corrected
to
occasion
speak
in
eneral COVERED
OF
The
fifths
Covered
progress
ntervals,
Covered
these
and in
has
progressions octaves parallel
OCTAVE
arise,
if
PROGRESSIONS.
already two
voices^
to
motion
been
an
-^ Covered
"
"
"
spoken starting or
octave
of, page
differen
with
fifth,e,
29.
g.
fifths :
^IseI^-^
"*"
i
of
nature
AND
FIFTH
f:
:". -fi.
1-r -"-
i
:t^
"
octaves: ""
-"._
' --
"
i_tfr^__
o
"
g-
^-
i__ .-
^p
I
These
fifths
voices
by
above
the
Since
an
the
be
heir
voices,
use,
If
one
2.
If
both
In
the
By
In
with
a
in
between
in
both
the
two
of
rules
for
been
yet
; there
however,
success*
therefore,
are,
furnish
will
a
standard
other
:
occur
can
voices
the
and
;
skips
the
middle
C.
Between
outer
Covered
FiftJis be
the kind
middle
if
allowed,
in
the upper
voice
b.
Fifths:
the
lower
of
voices
voice* :
voice.
Octaves
and
voice f
and
voices, a
in
step
concerns
and
the lower
in
skip a
and
voices,
Between
a
and
as
b.
an
^
cases
outer
a.
step
upper,
the
to
a
the upper
Between
are
not
succeed
which,
positive
view
cases.
hy
R.
They
made,
give
has
cases,
difficulty
great
to
attempt
for all
nearer
somewhat
to
are
others
also, since
:
skip to
a
leading
the
as
well
octaves
and
skip.
case
step
regard
is indicated
as
fifths
as
and
take
An
to be
moves
voices
a
to
sufficient
octaves
and
voice
first
h.
both
or
one
which
covered
chords,
limited,
much
for especial
fifths
By
be
of
choice
appearance.
observations
Covered
skip
lie between,
which
certain
necessary
would
criticism
a.
very
probably
general
1.
be
their
would
the
becomes
it
which
of
tones
the
movement
which
would
of
ul, and
nly
four-voiced
without
manner
if the
open,
points.
avoided,
he
by
filled out
in every
occur,
f
be
make,
become
octaves
and
Outer
the
by
progresses
Oda/tM:
e.
Vbices.m
a
step.
d.
35.
Here
it
ovement
ot
the
as
ose
which
ord
of
the
must
of
adinff tone^
remain
Although
"
one
exhibit sixth,
c,
remember the or
Bass,
in
the
a
as
stationary,
in parallel
go above
rule
Example,
above
be
voice
if all voices
well,
Remark.
We
well, if
or
so
pply,
is
first
is
a
general,
rate
very
also,
pages
No.
over
36,
the
in
Example
of
so
335
a^
the contrary
h,
It is
""
voices,
still it cannot
cases,
many
is not
which
shows,
the
No.
in
(c?).
motion in
led
time
same
since
to be
the
always among
reckoned
from
progression
the
one.
has and
the
suffice
d^
836
leading
forced
what 36
will
at
been
before
concerning
covered
octaves
said
viz., that
are half-step,
always
more
the
which
cadencing pass
tolerable
over
than
progress the
thost
In
the
exercises
undamental
e
more
much
the
of
p
third
the
be used
more
of
itself the
as
chord
cautiously.
not:
not:
836.
to
shows
always
it forms
therefore
and
questionable,
octave
in which
cases
;
chord
the
above,
exhibited
I
3!:S:
g
*
^-
.""Even
fifth of
as
the
it is not
chord
he
the
With
"
covered
called
good*
I^g^
33T.
Remark.
be
to
fifth, the
lower
will
voice
be
always
fundamental
the
o
chord.
fifths in
C"yf;ered
the outer
are
voices
to be
refectedif
the
voice
upper
kips, ""
P^
e"
i^--
251
""
ci"
j^^
I
:^ -^
a.
i
g
38.
t
m^^=\ Wherever hf
df
a
Covered
f
the
in
octaves
voice
upper
1 the
makes
seventh
the progression
Cf
jte-
^ -"^
the outer
""0-
connection
fifths appears
of
voices
Zr^
{"c^.-^
are
harmony
the
of more
covered
and
to be unconditionally
not
firmer,
as
less harsh.
refecte
skips. h,
d,
nor*
not
:
g"^^
HfcJS^j5i""^E
=g:
^
39. 6 p
Here
also
hemselves
36
and
Covered
to
337
those
be
cases
most
applies
fifths and
in which
the
What
tolerable. for d octaves
and in
Bass
"
r
^
"
a
progresses was
said
j^Nv^
r
p^
1
half-step
in connection
(jo)show with
Nos
""
the
outer
voices
are
to be
rejectedif
both
I
^Ea:
^^
J^
-0=4^=35-
Iz
-"-
-o-
s
,"s^.
^"O^riO
40.
J^
"rt*-
"!*"
"^
rJ^
-"^
I
B
I -"-
If, however,
be
o
octaves
nd
at
faults,
as
considered
inversions
form
;^Aey only
since
the
same
they
are
of
in that
case
they
chords not
are
not
fifth
progressing
all.
.c -"-
5"
fi^
341. -fi
"?
jO.
^g
i -fl-
Covered
Although
hat
of
epend
ave
place
a
Covered the
of
fifths, upon
of
fifths.
relation
overed
leading
occasionally
covered
ood
and
still their
outer,
them
llows
he
the
the
Fiftlis
from
aside
an
otherwise
here
the
situation, greater
the
freedom
; this
here,
be
above
as
by
good
for
the
; with
all
harmony.
pure
latter,
the
sake
respect
will
A
to
applies
particularly
observations, of
just
covered
if only
called
Voices.
be
must
is much
connection
good
Middle
which
are,
to
not
the
voices
middle
octaves
voices,
in
Octaves
of
the
to
the
immediately few
cases
may
:
noti
w
^
js:
43.
k
m
^^
Covered
^{^g^l^tsj^,^
-"--T -g:
^
=Ete
\
Fifths
and
s between
Octaves
the
Outer
and
Middle
Voices.
The
considerations
which
are
to
be taken
into
account
in connection
with
harmony,
onneotion
of
al rules.
Here
some
are
i
than
rather
through
established
meohani
merely
:
examples
^^^^^^^^
-tf?-
43.
1^=1
not
good:
m.
-"^
rS:
kind
the
over
pass
^^^^1
-"-
.a.
especial
of
still to be
is
octaves
in all voices,
these,
;
m^
7^
covered
seventh
I
-G-
not:
I
An
f-r^:
-"g-^-g-r-^-^i^^T^'^r-^^T-g1
9J
are
viz., such
mentioned,
to be
faulty.
as
avoided
44.
g
'
a
IE
" "
i
e"^s?
?"=*'-^.
"JSi
i?g^-pg^
Iee^I^^^
h":
-"-
s:
I
Soprano,
etween
Tenor
The
it
that
axim, to
do
tructure,
i
ection
ort
be
indeed,
of
safe if
such
takes as
fifths on
the
place, melodic
and
the
hand,
one or
on
and
8u"Gice, if for
of
voice-movement,
as
much otherwise
the other,
manifold
adduce
following
the
who
stil
mechanically-harmonic
requirements
an
so
to
beginners
those
properly
as
are
possible, add
covered
themselves.
appear,
we
entirely, as
of the voices
fact,
unisons.
avoided
regarded
can
in
were,
octaves
and
be
octaves
written
higher
the
to
chord
may
or
are
are
if it
not
technical,
regarding
harmony
prevail;
is
sure,
covered
as
fifths
observations
the
with
they
superfluous,
above to
the
be
to
84.)
page
also to covered
applies
latter
of the
postion
covered
be
octaves,
however,
the
to
without
however,
hem,
and
Bass,
would
which,
Avoid,
Tenor,
and
The
all.
ave
Alto
in which
cases,
hem
of
according
"
the
remarked
was
etween
taves
"
HO-
(See
which
"?
"
.-b:
That
11
'
-"-
art
:
possible
;
natural,
considerations
application
consider good
of
a
con^
higlver
of definiU
168
After
this digression,
correction
ategory
of
if the
even
the
both
where
ecause,
he
to
return
330,
No.
in order
to
before
the
correct
fault.
entioned A
we
voices
skip,
in
found
there,
be
hardly
will
Bass-progression
itself again
evil presents
fifth
covered
in
proceed e,
place,
another
belongs
which
possible the
contrary
in
in
thai
this
case,
movement,
g.
i
pi 345.
ggg^g^ Thus
it only
nother
marking
The
to
remains
fundamental
of the
following
alter, in this
alteration
place
F
I
harmony
itself, and
select
ISl
1
tones.
take
can
the
caise,
:
e"
O
:e: -"-"-
I ^-
r
46.
-*"
F
6 6
6
8
6
"!3$:
-"-
is:
i
: F
e.
bo
a:
P
"
"TSL
2:
-9-
^
47.
47
p
6
6 6
6
8
-G-
as
1
-"-
t
Exercises* 1. -^
ft
.=1 P
I
I
s_. -^
F
Bb
F
F
Bb
"ty
Cty
F
2. JO.
li^
3C .a.
t
OF
MANhAL
64
HARMONY.
8.
=^-
\
'jST.
iz
IS.
" F
Bfe
Bk 4. -""
.a.
i
""-
{ "^-zk
i^F
O
following
The
o
D.^
o
O
O
O
"^
48
in this
out
work
i
-"9-
:az
""^te
e.will
-^
ZJSL
manner
:
1.
8.
2.
40.
t
F
:
exercise e
F
O
D
6 4
4.
6.
6 6
8
"^ faults
The
movement
No.
1, is not
this work
of
third
voice
armonic No.
ecause
It has the
seventh
already Thus,
none
that
one
and
only can
skips
first
take
can
or
stationary
by
-""
free
enter
(pages place
by 72
without stationary
examples
here
which
is crowded
remain
following
ices.
50.
the
hy skips,
fault,
same
mentioned
take
of the
~--G
by
voices,
in parallel
principles
of
motion,
moni all har-
necessary.
fundamental
so
can
present,
figures.
against
means
voices^
the
been
already
by
place a
if through
only
motion), the
contrary
is preserved.
and
position,
no
remaining
contains
seventh
wkward
f
tone
connection 2 also
two
or
three
it offends
is by
and
indicated
upper
since
good,
of one (by a
are
all the
of
connection
leading
m
-"-
The
A
7
the
and
becomes
thereby
come
harshness,
in the
exhibit
into
an
other.
158), that
and
still harsher
a
free
the
if the
same
superior
entrance
fundamental
voice.
leading
of
the
few
Probably
important
re
The
of
still
mB.j
examples
fundamental
the
would
be
completion
of
contrary
motion,
instances
similar
and
for
excusable
reasons.
melodic
following
uction
these
of
as
serve
in
the seventh
and
intro-
free
the
mentioned
158.
page
I^^S
9sh
toiitzSzi^^^intE
51
s^m The
to
the
No.
Example
2, of
No.
down
laid
rule
he
chord
of
the
sixth
and
fourth,
he
chord
of
the
sixth
and
fourth.
of
Example
The
s tho
fault
third more
The
ot
as
the
; that
leading
following
The
:g=^
of
the
Alto,
the
will be
a
is
5 as
better
with
be
the
in
the
; it
as
of
out
working
Bass
the
the
in the voices. it
that
ground in
motion.
No.
348.
i
s-
rg:
"
""-
was
connection
in contrary
Exercise
of
the
of
place
from
skip
Soprano
the
with
fifth, which
leading
take
can
not
covered
of
on
condemned,
31
^
the
skip
connection
zS:
Aj
59.
jSL
"lt^
i
-"
1
IS.
6 4
6
6
%
8
7
Mxerdses. 1. .^L
h.
859.
"
I
this, another
should
scattered
better well
Bass
consists
general
4 is to
No.
at
(page 163), in
viz., that
349
besides
contains
above
No.
in
as
well
349,
connection
fifth in No.
covered
necessary
ith
in
prominent
direction,
ame
:*i:"fe2_ 21
instance
ault, contrary
m
-*
31 ZOL
^p tt^
O
G
"
"
D
A
B
G
2.
^
.JOt.
O
-"-
^
2s:
ISL
J"i^
G
OF
MANUAL
166
HARMONY.
"
-G
r-Q.
^
^=m
^
G
The
D
~
next
I
ith
O
O
O
D.
B
A
A
B.y
fr7
3:
ff iii f
I
E7
~
"
"a? -"-
following
the
B
"
exercise^ B
53.
Bi
"
treatment
:
^
HEg
^Ei
J\
54. ^1
^-^^
i lis
ves
to
opportunity
speak
progressions,
mmediately
In
order
to
lone
Notwithstanding of
rinciples to
e,
For
this
has
rought
this
so
forward
natural
books
the
without
a
55.
of them
will be
here
tone
in
in the
of
practice
tons
one
raised
Bass.
in
applied
degree,
can
reason
to
that
voic"^
all theoretical
is hardly
there
be
later
cross-
cross
the
:
of
the
unharmonic
adduced
the
the
:
he
to
great
instruction
examining
G||of
progression,
of
upon
to
before occurs.
so
and
belongs
chromatically
rule
are
immediately
aulty.
Some
the
following
the
doctrine
the
upon
Alto
the
of
exceptions
in which
manner,
of
voice,
another
answers,
rule
in the cast
name,
in this ; that
in general m
connection
many
reason,
been
G
the
unaltered
harmonic
which
tone
alterations
tone
the
same
this fault, note
chromatic
which
consists
upon
avoid
Immediate in
here
as
and
the
follows
depressed^
the
harmonica)
{relationon
cross-relation
unharmonic
mmelodic
bears
which
OROSS-BELATIOK.
UNHARMONIO
The
fault
a
of
shown.
methods,
relation, relations
why
any
great
and o^cur
they
do
suspici
instances in not
a
fect per-
sound
167
h.
ff*
m it^^iit-^ Ie^^ -fS^
'^ p^^
".^f X
In
all these
the
character
first needs
hat
this kind
ivisions
herefore
hich
original are
the
proof,
at
for
the
because
of
above
the
contraction,
d^
the
is the
E^ ^
P
]
-'^
^
above :
^
"-
eg
^
j^ h.
I
#
P=t
m
1 T
f
smaller rare
and
cross-relations,
^
^^
Let
g
added,
foundation
:tf5=3=n:
6.
J
the
4^=^4 ifi:
is
be
for embellishment.
"Li Jsi
with
notes
harmonic
following
e.
to
mostly
serve
with
cir*
Jl.
in half
which
too
constrvAytion^
occur
simple
the
contraction
observation
notation
voices
through
or
f^
e^
through
either
metrical
it the
elements, of
progression
the
probably
through
tonic
b^ g^
a^
is only
would
but
voices,
c^
at
j
there
and
and
those
result
notes
connections
measure,
not
and
the
j
cross-relations
unsuitable,
pressed, The
of the
of
no
of
hut
natural
harmonic
mstantial
forward
formed
not
appears,
relation
changing
of
drawing together)of The
cross
leading
imply-harmonic In
the
oases
rJr
m No.
355,
i
All
re
these
through
conditions, in the
wanting
following
which
cases,
similar
and
are
cross-relations
most
faultj
tl^erefore
are
which
cndurahla
57.
In
the
all
from
he
their
tempo,
ical
the
which
make
will
the
added
brought
whole
all
separat
consideration
by
out
formations
these
the
is reckoned
TrUomLS^
name
the
and
Of tritonus
istance
from
means
not
o
of
ryth"
unpleasant,
but
This
fourth
the
to
progression of
explanation
follows
which
is known
which
here
:
Tritonus.
the
in the
is contained
a
also
diatonic
the
seventh
embraces
three
degree
(in
the
0
the
embraces
scale, and
major
major
scale
th
fourth F-B.)
ugmented
from
step
s derived
F
to B
It is held especial
to
W:
p
be
unmelodic
progression,
voices
and
the
s transferred
because
each
appear
properly
name
of
its tones
assigned
to
requires two
fer dif
:
^p^.
one
to
mnst one
disregarded
remain
voice
its progression,
1.-
t
I
1=t melodic
in
:
360.
the
its
whence
I
unvocal tones
which
"*""
f which
tone-steps^
whole
:
358.
nless
a
of
cross-relations
The
n
consistency
be
still to
but
practice,
precise.
Among
nder
is
from
taken
are
which
connection,
the
of
divisions,
ather,
instances,
above
succession
be
formed
thus
:
i
if the step
That
interval-step,
his
hich
is
jusb
Remabk.
That
triad
this
armonic
easy
and
samOj
s
42.
f=* of
the
as
performance,
in this
remarked,
formerly
was
step
in
that
coimection,
becomes
as
plain
of
the
tritonus
appears
from
depends
tritonus
Example
Ko.
as
avoided
which,
things
ts situation can
one
Upon
two
manner
based
occur,
Upon
its
and
upon
862
above.
chords
of
itself. simply
is to be
the
At
only
the
simple augmented
day,
with
the
among
the
ment aug-
this
leading
with
had
in
customary
reckoned
harmonic
least, used
at
formed
lay
the
of
voices,
are
tritonus,
are
caution.
in the
use
of the
appearance.
either
{a)
chord
in ajjwre
reference
which
it is
means,
or
unmelodic,
to
exhibited
faulty,
as
up
otherwise
it
tone-compositions,
artistic
progressions,
the
with
diatonically
all
held
especially
connection
of
which use
xtended
s
of
progression,
^F=t
its progression,
and
that,
rogression
It
voiced
used
the
4
I
formation
The
two
often
inversion
o
effect
unpleasant
38).
page
be
very
the
of
is:
still be
^It may
"
ircumstance,
o
the
a
reason
only
refractory.
diminished
See
by
require
intelligible
as
the
shown
likewise
would
ifficult and
he
is
"62.
nd
is not
this, however,
or
(")^ e.
g.
363.
If
it
occurs
in
prepared;
orced
the
which
one
chord,
connection
is easily
progression
Formerly
hirds^
upon
prohibition
follow
each
its entrance two
with
is not
chords,
and
unexpected,
however,
the
the
ear
feeling
of
two
maj(r
a
produced. of
other
the at
tritonus the
was
distance
extended of
a
not
^^"^^^^^^^^^
whole however
to
the
step, :
e,
g.^
MANUAL
170
ame
not
in the
appear
Q
^l"
inor
former
he
return
step
^
g
from
this step, to
again
*
our
fourth
not
the
to
the
Exercise
353,
No.
is:
""
-"-
-"-
366.
Ao.
"^-
ii^ 6
treatment
I
I ":
^
same.
better
a
attempt
upon
nies. its harmo-
the
remains
and
of the
founded
itself, and
scale
minor
is
tri tonus,
as
degree
seventh
it is augmented,
since
^f
""
reckoned
of
milder.
much
i
^-^
the
G^, was
to
effect of
is rendered
/
representation
usual
The
We
the
g,^ D
e,
scale,
fonr-i oiced, espeeiallj
and
1^-7^^ 3
365.
formerly
three
same
voices,
outer
4
That
HARMONY
the
effect, whereas
nnpleasant
f it does
OF
i
6 6
Exercises* 1.
66
ft.
-^
-"-
la:
I
:sl
t^ .^^ F
"
bO
7 2. le: -^
i
i:^
f?^ E
bO
'* 8.
i^
fe:
rro:
^^ Hi B.
ii|i"
Bi
4.
"-
is:
^
-"-
1
:~'g"
f^ * 2.
Harmonic
This
egin
exercise, too
early.
to
accompaniment
which
belongs
a
given
properly
It is introduced,
to
for the
middle the
voice.
contrapuntal
present,
with
the
labors,
addition
cannot
of the
Exercise. Alto
0
^^'M"L
In
O
F
G
A
C
G
Oiy
S
"9-
treatment
the
be
again,
"
Soprano,
the
of this exercise,
the most
as
Bass.
the
of
sketching
first and
the
prominent
At
the
be
can
voice,
important
most
time,
same e,
added,
I -"2-
-p-
^
0
G
0
will
however,
the
g.
ISI^i!!?^
36".
thing
1
ra: "-"-
"5
F
G
G
Diy
0
i
w
zza: -"-
1-^
H-ffl.
jQ-
6
The
ion
foregoing
of
can
it will
Tenor
the
answer
this form
assume
; through
movement
the
addi-
:
"O"
:s:
-JSl
1
221
g:
-jz. -^
69.
""
three-voiced
a
as
"3:-Ti="" 7~P-
""-
-"?
^-
"l-
I
.IS. "IT
-"1"-
""-
6 6 6
JE^6rci"68
with
Alto.
given
1.
*"
iffi:
3^
^^ Gty
-6?-
D
F
C
ei^
-^
H F
Bb
O
3. -"
^-
t^^
ZSl
0
Bb
F
Ti??:
is: ::is:
ZgE
s F
F
6
4. -^
te
:r^:zz:t e
C
F
"
o
C^
7
A
^7
'*
6.
50Ez
-"-
is:
i
6. 3:
r-"=i.
^S Tenor
voice
be
would
1
Bb
-7
A
F=T^
in like
treated
manner.
Eocercise. c
Tenob.
|l"5EE
370.
Sketcli of
01
c
the
Bass
i Soprano
and
:
m
m 371.
ill
Jl
-Q2Zia.
6
4
Four-voiced
:
^sz
^~ ^~g"^:ji^^:^^p=^-
I
s: -"-
372.
"-.^-T^-
^1
-"
j-"-
6 4
JEkvercises
with
Tenor.
given
1.
b.
72
2.
$55^^
T-^r-
T-5"
-Q
-"-
0
e
0
G7
A
.-(2.
I
^
^
"
-yfe
i
6.
D
8.
l^^
-G-
*
-G--
0
0
G.y
-O-
"
C
4.
1^
"
T
fz^^Eg E.
These
ell At
as
^%^
exercises the
the
leading
close
of
are
of this
to
the
ill
-"-
be
continued,
voices
chapter
until
in general,
it should
be
A
the is
".
"
of
sketching
perfectly
remarked,
pure that
the and
to
a
Bass,
as
certain. good
oar*
especially
be overstepped,
wo
voices,
In
this
Of
the
dmits
of
e
"
would
set
for
one
too
one
The
octave.
be
rule
relation
of
otes
^To set the
appear
free
exercises
present in
exactly
harmonic
in
former
the
two
The
to
apply
tone. :
noted
to
one
the next
Bass
the
to
the
must
not
he
howevefy
Tenor y
Bass,
the manner,
will
be
not
Basses.
figured
as
to the
purpose, They
since
can
only
Harmonic
iri whole
notes,
in
in
half
the other
the
situation
Accompaniment.
harmonic
the
accompaniment
This
voices.
take
can
place,
chords,
change
Through
not
toe
XVIII.
the
of
interchangeably
Through
be
not
treatment.
voice
given
Through
does
not
exceptions,
Extension
a
must
must
other
however,
from
CHAPTER
To
the
one
upon
distance
the
voices^
this,
;
themselves
voices to
voice
meet
following
the
of
small
example,
let the three
upper
than
hey
for
which,
reater
Remabe.
it be
must
relation
from
distance
the
neither
reat,
boundaries
the
;
necessary
of
of
one
chord,
suspensions.
exercises
will
be
in the
marked
same
manner
as
heretofore.
Exercise. F"
f
"^*-| The
Bass
can
P
bO
Giy
A"
Y
i
"G" -G-
Jfl-
be sketched
in this
manner
:
74.
In
the
second
and
fourth
measures,
sevenths
of
secondary
chords
of
thi
MANUAL
174
Tt
kind
iS
f th?
an
chord,
called
and
passing
They
sevenths. the
upon
appear
always
HARMONY.
from
start
In
arsis.
the fundamental a
such
they
manner
in all voices.
occur
The
he
are
GF
following
the
of
addition
four-voiced
^
to
voices
middle movement
the
sketch
above
^
-JSL -"-
F=f ,
^-
i
-JST.
^:3$^E
i
-""
6
2
6
a
with
exercise
3:
-pIZ
ifi^
2
same
gives
.
75.
The
Bass,
a
of
richer
change
of
8
harmony
7
be given
can
in this
:
nner
G
I
376.
Fij^Of^
i"i"
ACi^b
o
c^7
g
-"-
JSL
i
.a:
is:
TrsatmerU
:
i IS f-^
P"-
""
^
-fi.
I
'I
77.
i3
GGt^ty
"s-
"a
^2-1-"-
y.ii te^g
"Tiis:
6
a:
9-
32:
?s:
4
7b
mk
6-8
3b
The
78.
next
exercise
nill exhibit
the
use
of
the
suspensions.
FBfxODoFBbOij'F
"
-jSl
m.
-"9-
R
i
Treatment:
ia:
la:
la:
iizs:
:2s:
-g***^
:g
f^r
r
79.
J.
J:
""^
^
IS "a
^
f
1
i
^
I
:":
^
"G-
t
J
"
^ t-
-fl-G.
We
pass
The
using
6
the
over
of the
simply
harmonic to
asure,
is given For
for
place
it in
its
in half-notes,
treatments
be
be very
for
of
drawn
the
AUa-breve the
exercise
purpose.
existing
moni har-
good
the
off, and
the
exhibit
in
place
selected
tones
easily
to
order
exercises,
(half-notes).If
divisions can
as
notes,
takes
as
fundamental
can
of chorals
viz., in
or,
chorals
the
in whole
purpose,
principal
then
practice
personal
this measure,
a
of
voices.
middle progression
melodic
content
exhibit
"
in the
exercises
(cantus firmus) took
imple
7
8
9
treatment
ttempted.
In
the
the
exercise
next
O
Choral:
Hanpt
Blat
vol!
be
will be
process
shown.
Wunden.
nnd
/TS A
80.
p
JtPf D^
BOiy wr"
E
"
A
E
"
-,
^i:
f=F
-O"
F
0
0
B"
F
O
0
O
A
D
Tb
A
"
AFJO
S
^
-g(-^
"^ "s.
0-.
fie f
A
133^
m
The
D
X
?
o
%
A"y
"
0
0
G
G
E
"
A
-"--
^ treatment
"Uowing
of
-"-
this
choral
i
can,
to
according
"Bl-
the
above
exercise,
:
/T\
%
1^
A
X
^
"
;
"".
I "
-G-
-"
it^ "
I
I "-
"
\
St^SL
-c^-
I
Sia
be
"
f
"-
I
J
i
"
-fi) :^ t=x
4"^
"
ff-
,
vi/ /7\
^
T^:
%
":
^
gO
1
r
"
I
I
i 2i
I
AAA
A
^
P
^
-^
:^
t:t=F
f
Sb/
After
su"Gicient
armony,
oices,
For
elody
by
means
the
of
this purpose
follow
in the
it
now
All
to
not
and, in order and will
use
treat
learn,
to
what
here
the
here
leading
the
of
the
farther
discussion
o
by
of Melody*
jyevelopment
of
the
in them
depend
XIX.
the
invention
important
is most
what
simple
progression.
On
are
the
chapter
next
CHAPTER
"We
of
the
notes.
changing
and
of
management
development
farther
a
passing
will
melodic
and
to
proceed
in the
certainty
and
practice
can
we
pment,
f
J=i
:stz-:
upon
for
of
is essentially the
but
melody,
harmonic
our
elaboration
a
exercises,
fashioning
and
of
of
its devel to
treat
melodies,
to
of
the
harmonic.
recognition
and
comprehension
Every
on
just
as
herefore,of
ssential
We
to
select
this
to
the
P
83.
a
subordinate
end
the
the
I^^i
as
are,
in the
four-voiced,
out,
carried
harmony
and
Ciy
P
m
.
.
-O-
melody
tones.
F
G"
the
manner
simplest
--
-9-
tht
develop
to
fundamental
the
of
-"-
Both
distinguish
to
endeavor in
P
-"-
admits,
work.
down
Bb
Bb
"
learn
and
indication
with
mode
above
write
will
last examples
our
complicated,
accessory
method,
founda
a
harmony.
of to
necessary
analytic
we
however
voices,
and
in
exercises,
connection
simple
the
which
melody,
ccording
e
from
the
of
as
used,
this, it is
recognize
notes
ollowing
to
have
we
leading
reduction to
order
those
as
simple
he^ has
it may
developed
and
extended
^
harmonic
Every
In
however
melody
selected,
following
.-a.
jO.
simple,
latter
the
and
may
:
manner
3: "-"-
":
JSt.
-G.
{83.
S:
is ^
-fi-
^
-"-
z:jS^. JQ.
6
I
!^^E
:3a:
igrdi^
G-
9i
^
%"" 6 4
Before-
we
to
ccesary
A
premise a
of
a
be
is to
what
development
farther
of this
mentioned
it beoomefl
movement,
the
concerning
mat for
rythmical
melody.
be
can
melody
ontaining
to
proceed
or
more
a
either
less
musical
measures, .as
omposition), or
it
can
be
a
whole,
movement
definite
without
it is often
found
separated
and
as
theme
bounded
boundary,
(motive by
means
of
o
ntithesos.
In
ight
the
last
case
measures,
ntitheses.
it is
which, These
a
called
in
antitheses
two or
Period,
and
divisions, divisions
it
each are
contains
then,
four
measures,
of
'^
often
called
thesis
as
a
rule
form
and
anti thes
The
treatment
complete
more
this
of
subject
belongs
to
is
seen
doctrine
the
o
Form.* That
the
above
the
whole,
and
of
This
the
of
point
Such
in
the
divisions
the
all, to seek
in
the
the
out
or
half-cadences,
as
close
separating
cadences,
themselves
show
as
which
i
plagal
movement.
the
a
measures,
be
may
periods
in the
close
seventh
and
sixth
of
in the
discovered
often
half-cadence (in general,
a
exercise
is very
whole
the
of
middle
period,
above
necessary,
separation
imperfect
as
either
it will be
a
divisions.
the
of
point
form
will
movement
the
and
be
to
assumed
at
in
is found
dominant)
o
point
separating
the
our
place
where
the
seven^
the
t stands.
sign
division,
first
The
four
contain
of
each
measures,
six
antithesis
thesis,
the
This
measures.
take
may
be
can
which
plete It
we
the
add
musical
period.
needs,
also,
into
transformations
admit
easure,
of
a
glance, kinds
various
easy
to
of
e.
measure,
accomplishment,
e.
F=^
^^t^F
that
see
^., into
?
"
farthei
all
?
1
,
com
a
obtain
^'^
"
g.
irt
"-i
to
us
enable
we
above,
selected
accompaniment
"
^
fc
385.
only
F
za
%
harmonic
:
manner
m
--fl-p-
-"-
-g-
to
r
O-
fe5$--^bg:
If
following
as
so
altered
rythmically
in the
place T
384.
receive
accordingly
would
t qc;i:4 TJSf
i^
-^
i
-0--W-
f=t "e.
^^
:^=p:
t
p^
*
t^t
s
*--"-!=
^f=F=t^ A".
A"
We
passing
and
fc
386.
*
proceed
See
now
changing
Ft!=F
the work
to
tonic
the
notes,
e,
variations
of
the
melody,
and
add
^g
t
t
m
t=f
" "
l
g.
^
of this author
to
Die
Onmdzuge
der muaikjiUiehen
Ibrmen/*
"
(Leiptk
P
mmt^^^g
-^'"-S^-J Still riche.'
%-se
all by-tonety
of
cou]d
give
following
the
turibation
:
Adagio.
|ll^feS?^-S^
:X^SEt""^
"7. Origin"ilhf
[^*
m
m
-ja.
%^J"(^i"jt^E!=.^E^S^^^ ^
^"E
^5,_..
I EicEte
ei; T-i^
1^ The
^
ith we
oice
to
reference add
the
the
the
harmony,
original
voices
other
however,
That,
voice.
below,
found
progression
melodic
simple
fundamental
he
f
:
will
immediately
recognized is carried
melody
above
deviations
the few
with
be easily
will
become
conditioned
by
the
Adagio, "
hi
"
I
1
'^'^
T
F^
"
"
'
#"i
^
'-r-y"
u
^"^?*^"H
""H""^
"
f
"8.
J
i
J
m
^^m "m
feEEl:
t
r
out
evident,
:
-B-:
as
upper
m ^ We
may
be
found
o
of
be
to
how
of
a
more
melodic
and
singly,
but
middle they
The
progression.
be
to
are
appear
as
only
for the
succession,
extended
voices,
intensifica
is, in this
movement
three-voiced.
as
independent
this
as
worth
development
what
in
the
that
example,
occur
not
in
parallels
this
of do
strength,
regarded
octave
measure
if they
harmonic
a
little
As
third
additional of
ase,
the
faultless
as
egarded
eans
in
the
concerning
remark
the
has, it still served,
example
simplest
and
melodic
harmonic
here,
to
i
movement
apable. The
harmonic
nd
the
interesting
following
fundamental
to
great
harmonic
recognition
and
contemplation
is too
relations
in the
xample
The
of
advantage
allow
us
to
forbear
these
of
melodic
to furnish
another
movement.
is
progression
just
as
simple
that
as
shown
efore. -^-
1:
rcSL
"o~
:g=:r^
^
"9.
'*ii
-^
T-"
-G
^^
-G-
il
IPI
g^T-g-Tp
G"'
j50-
s:
m^^m This
We
ivision
jQ.
forms
movement
alf-cadence omit
of
3:
T""-
the
here
seventh the
a
period
; the
1 middle
close
is easily
found
measure.
various
kinds
of
measure,
and
select
the
:
i "i::;2
90.
i^E^
in the
:^.
following
The
de^relopment
anneii
o^ the being
reference
had
to
fm^'K
What
~rxr
ft
the
part
other
from
movement
393.
'
the
A(Uigw,
^
voices
in
place
the
following
:
progression
^
""4
Ms ~
I
h
"
"J
p
*
EliB
^^
in melodic
El? major quartette
^
"
f=?
take
can
development,
Beethoven
of
the
will
show:
1"
!
^F"
I
1
r"
"1----'"
:fe
L
ViOLEHO
following
^ 4
ViOLINO
harmonic
the
91
take
may
voice
upper
II.
TlOLA..
OLONOJlLLO.
^ E"HS3^ [^
^-
-^^
^ii^^^
^-"3p
l^edl
^^ "
s
i^
S^i^FS^S^
^
"p
A
comparison
with
No.
390
will
the
show
harmonio
melodic
and
original
melody,
ariations.
There
now
follows
still another
alteration
of
the
out
of
MANUAL
182
OF
HARMONY.
te^^
93.
"^T-* nx\'^Tj'i. Ill)
a
l^^^^^^^^ij^^^^
e
The
he
in
reference
personal
practice
hints
These left to
Bemabk.
^The
"
for
just
following
alteration
could
(even
above not,
:
to
practical
side, and
in the
proceed
set
partly,
that
in the to gain
a
proceeding
whole
in composition in
light
clear
the
insight
one
later
the
otherwise),
right
here, suffice, and
may,
guidance.
special
if Beethoven,
sometimes,
objectnpartly,
only
development
melodic
or
it is
as
certain
to
element
mechanical
so
shown
way
elodies,
r
show
394.
ake;
he
in the
themselves
Toices
other
in
even
not
great
of
our
not
of a
proceed these
degree
previous
was
i
original
it here
exercises
compositions
complicated
mis*
occasion
always
alterations so
relation into
should does
t
theno-
elves.
f
As
the
concerns
the
howed
It yet
manner
simple
themselves,
remains
ill be done
accompanying
to
of
voices,
harmonizing,
even
if subordinate,
speak
concerning
in the next
chapter.
other
they
arose
little
required still
not
kinds
of
on
that
themselves alteration, account
of accompaniment,
out
and
nifica insig-
whiot
On
The
JDevelopment
last examples the
nner
foregoing
the
of
have
chapter take
voices
accompanying
Voices.
Accompanying
tJis
of
harmonic,
in
part
in what
shown
already
metrical
and
development.
elodic
There
however,
are,
the
mder
name
still other
is not
This
nstrumental
a
ones,
e.
limited
only
of the vocal
character
be treated
will
is
parts, and
known
are
for
be used
may
following
the
investigation,
of. the
understood
kind
of
of
the
transformation
uniform
metrically
In
manner.
accompaniment
through
rising
to the
very
music
figurated
By
which
of accompaniment,
ACCOMPANIMENT.
FIGURATED
adapted in
only
kinds
of THE
hem
accompaniment
chord-
simple
g. Simple
FigwaUd
harmony:
:
aceompaniment
a.
i^"
"
^^mr"^5
^^fr^^^^ crf"lftt"# The
are
that
nd
rom
at a
accompaniment
herefrom
n
XX.
CHAPTER
at
the
Any
kinds This
is melodically
c
formed
are
select
of
with the
other
That
be
can
used
at
The
Jigurated, changing
and for
figures
be
figurated have
arisen
figuration,
either
alone
voices.
beginning
preceded
which
arising
notes.
passing such
figures
6 is metrically
of
Example
382,
in
remarks
:
No.
accompaniment.
may
The
Jigurated.
chords.
from
voice
accompanying
connection
We
also broken
called
last
is harmonically
by
the
following
order
to
attempt
soma
or
184
MANUAL
ll the
he
rules
CHANGE
We
of OF
must
the
harmonic CHORDS,
THE
not
OF
write
HARMOHTY.
leading as
US
Well
of
the
to he
are
voices
ai
ol served
the redupUcation.
tu
: or: ^
T
!_^^"J-_j"_^,
h^
_^
396.
i
9jm
ut
in this
somewhat
"
:
manner
Z4^J.J^J^
97.
I
I -"
At
ote
the
of
change
the
next
of
the
harmony,
not
must
form
the a
last note
false progression
better:
not:
of
figure
one
with
any
and
other
firs
the voice,
e,
g
not:
-:^ izzrzL
9".
a fu^
i
I
^
better:
.0--
js:
f-y-
i
"
i
.A: -Gl
The
harmonic
in greater
ovements
99.
figuration
Ons
also
perfection.
affords
The
the
means
examples
for forming
will begin
with
one-voiced this
:
voiced:
i^^^N^^^ ^"LU
y-r
m
m^ 4e.
^-fzfX=fl
zJt
That a
these or
violin
00*
movements
Two
clarionet,
are
is easy
to
be
an
instrument,
voiced:
t -"-
"
X
Three in
the
two
m
:fcE
voiced:
middle
in
voices:
in
in
sucl
probablj
seen.
X
P
The
for
calculated
the
npper
the
lower
voice:
voice:
voices:
figuration
in
the
four-voiced
movement,
after
the^e
attempts
witl
Instead
he
of
following
this
we
passage
to
prefer from
as
select, the
an
above
example
quoted
figuraticm,
of manifold
movement
quartette
o
eethoven.
i^-
m
""^-"^-fbg-f-y-f^g
01. piM.
:fl"=la
1^^^^ "%
-$
-^^=F=^=^^:^^^^-^E^.
1=^^=^: cre8C
I "
T^^H^
I"
J
I
I
n^ijii:
ii--r-jLj-j-
P:#=i=i
1^ #
ii^^"=^M
If
I
t
,-
^-
^-
This
whole
rich
development
and
392,
and
90,
391
he
voices
If
^^lE^Ig^-^l^feEg
we
is carefully
wish an
at
rrive
ery
of
a
obtain
reduce
harmonic
inner
their
of
in this
kinds,
The
With
being
our
back
by
itself
reward
it
structure,
kind
this
of
will
by
and
few
Eocercises
hitherto,
most
ppears
to
make
begin,
the and
o
to
capable
rendered
simple
of
of
be
will
their
enrichment
and
knowledge
formationfl
also
the as
of much
leading
before,
of
with
8
i?p
XXI.
tlie
four-voiced
form it
the
7
voices
more
ird: 3= M
the
and
three-voiced
especially
skillful
and
many-sided.
lated calcu-
Basses.
figured
0
for
used
completeness,
greater
are
with
%l
6
been
they
since
problems
has
writing
connections,
advantage,
the
of
affords
harmonic
the
Movement.
Three^aiced
although
for
adapted are
ovements
in
exceptions,
exercises
"""
leading
compositions,
elaborated
harmonic
CHAPTER
We
the
Nos.
own*
our
r
in
enters,
change
into such
insight
clear
compositions
; industry
many
the
given
observed.
understanding to
useful
oundation
f
to
upon
wherever
foundation
the
rests
4
6
S
4 3
6
6
%
^
32:
m -"
-^
The
;
of the in
the
case
rule, the fifth
which
The
fundamental
an
the
especial
treatment
will be added
the
can
can
mode,
third, in
a
is the
exercise
following,
naturally
itself.
the
as
few
to which
cases,
As
a
movement,
interval
without
few
a
remarks
:
NB
^^=^-
^
i^B
6
6 sn
js: -"-
^a.
;ti
"^
^
(^
-"
^
-""-
-jBT.
w^^ 403.
must
emptiness.
of the
4
%
; the
cases
the
its intervals
of
in the four-voiced
be omitted
only
one
of
be the seventh
occurred
in many
also
triad, but
the
interval
one
never
has already
as
omission
the seventh
of
chords
be omitted,
in
result
this, however,
;
determines
producing
will often the
for
is sufficient, indeed,
moyement
of
can
the
and
-"-
voices
be wanting
always
-9"
-iS^
three-voiced
leading
6 5
-""
"-T-^
-P
":.m. 2^ 8
m 8
the
second,
6 4
6 6
6
4
i9r
2
6
ig"G2.:
diminished
triad,
Bb-C-E-G,
voices, this place
is found,
measure
would
stand
the
thus
i^
at
NB., It
the
stands
fundamental :
f
12
11
E-G-Bi?.
of which
"+"
]pi~
10
9
NB.
In the fourth of
7
chord
of the sixth and
instead
of
the
chord
C is here omitted.
For
fourth of
th^j
four'
OF
MANUAL
189
HARMONY,
404.
Oonceniing In
can
ave
n
ng
used
upon
third
of
the
emains,
the
the
lace
of
voices)
in
the
fundamental
here,
of
the
fourth
and
the
that
the
original
the
the
sixth
better
lead
fourth
alon"
chord.
case
of
the
take
occasionally
will
can
chord
a
of
yet,
sixth,
passing
sake so
in
movement,
probably
the
fifth of
especially
second,
as
three-voiced,
the
movement,
chord
(for
and
third
movement,
can
chord
omitted
two-voiced
e.
eventh,
be
and
sixth
the
a
although
two-voiced
fourth
four-voiced
the
fundamental
the
the
in
arsis
the
Now,
chord.
can
as
155.
page
in the
nor
chord,
complete
of
the
represents
three-voiced
chord
the
marking,
In
fourth
the a
of
worth where
of
in
is mentioned
what
compare a
measure
neither
the cases
e
fifth
the
ourth
this chord,
the
passing:
g.
J
I
405.
Four-voiced,
the
I
""-
Isl
a:
^t=F
No.
in Example
place
above
403
would,
complete,
stan^
the
sixtb,
hus:
W^^^ 406.
6 5
6b 4
i9r
""
In
the
ourth The
eighth
measure
third
is, by
and tenth
measure
undamentally,
ourth,
third.
which
Four-
the here,
of the
of
exhibits
however,
No.
Example
skip
fifth here
I
p
the
403, formed
Alto,
apparently
a
nothing
else
is
through
this becomes
the
chord than
progression :
the
chord
of
complete. of the
of
the
sixth
suspension
the
Bass,
and
fifth of
the
becomes
407.
The
that
triad
the
That
the
the
of
measure
closing
can
of appear,
omission
voices,
is
of
in such the
403
cases,
even
first
the
and
third
and
by
conditioned
second
th*
through
shows, without
is often
third
by
shown
No.
Example
octb^if
fifth.
leading
the
measures
t
of
the
next
example.
"-5^
40".
6
*
I^E
T-^^""-
^^
^
m
6 43-
-
9^F ^?-
The
ast
he
omission
of
7
366
4-J
the
division
measure), the
Farther
^
in
third
to
are
the
A-fiH-'
place
the
thesis,
should
be
i
6
takes
; upon
third
exercises
Exercises
-"-T
"^:^t _prf_.-"_.
.a_".
measural
#
""
G-
r
^^sm^
not
be
left to
best
upon
the
arsis,
(accordingly at
the
atf
here
in the
beginning
o
wanting.
the
especial
Movement
Three-voiced
guidance
to
a
[of the teacher given
Upper
Voice.
The
following
exercise,
with
indication
of the
fundamental
tones,
is l
Q
e.
F
"
-9-
I
09
"p TrBoiment:
10.
fundamenUU,
This
treatment
The
choice
the
f
in
chords
oice,
will
lower
For
simple
in
Ga
i"fj "3t
"p^
13.
to
more
just
the Tenor
so
the position
Tenor
the
position,
more
as
be
can
middle
selected
on
while
harmonic
D
middle
since
voice,
the
Land
other
itself, isolated.
of
a
qP^i ^
-^V
.
as
selected
Bass,
the
extended GO
"a
is
appears,
""
i
11
Alto,
Tenor
the
Soprano
Exercise
previous
low
npon
Bass.
the
itself
the
will depend
voices a
the
than
example
of
song
in
Thus,
of
attaches
lower
and
suitable
following
the
The
middle
instead
voice
explanation.
general.
more
ts movement
he
the
of
be
no
needs
treatment s
D
D
: c
Gi^
n.
s:
m
Treatment:
Si
^
-"-
ISl
i
n^ B3:I
-"-
-"-
is:
ISL
-"-
nms^
-"-
"^
6 5
i^ iiafc
6
-6f~fS-
t
M
X
It
6.-57
i
^fa^rfpi^irjl^f NB.
In
he
the
fifth
position
etween
of
Tenor
at
the
voices),as
and
econd-suspension
ion
of
the
NB.
measure
seventh,
Bass. cannot
and
appears
second, In
this
real
connection
itself
the
seldom,
very
it is to be
depends
second
according
(through
ninth-suspension
occurs
which
exist, because governs
the
to
the
and
remarked, upon
the
progression
only
that
a
inver*
of the
IwfertUm
or:
.*
in
Exercise TsiroB.
14.
I^^^Pt
p
413.
a
keEEEEbsiEE^I rf
middle
voice.
A
Bt^C
"D
fekt^=^"g-|
""
upper
Toice,
L
^m
the
g
1-^
Alto
the
is here
to
most
3E
"
"
-"
of
selection
A
d
cf^w
"
1^^
.
As
gb*i"
the
purpose.
-s:
e
-"-
-"""-
^
15.
-"""
"
3
i^gj
"!
"
6
:s:
^P
"
.
-"
I
i
'"
-fiL -O-
The
16
17.
same
Exercise D
%
o
I?-J
with K"rj
the
determination
following
BI^GCFBbOi^D
of
A
BI^FoxOd
|?:i|iEJi|?
ig^
2s:
2s:
:
chords
-"-"-
7V"a"m"nf.*
gS
|"E^E
5=P:
i^
ISt
BS'^EEji?
:^ :^
e
-^
7
J
6
-
i
5_^P3E^
"
St |^_J_^_^_
-"-"-
is:
:?5=": "
.a
%
i
6 "
'"
-""
t
198 The
be
to
next
the
last
measure
the
affords
farther
practice,
voiced
movement,
may
former
exercises,
great
point
of
view,
allows
If,
in
even
applied
in
ble,
still the
rom
the
must
The
of
in connection
fifth or
the
hen,
of
be
the
successions
completeness,
one
or
the
metrically
the
two-voiced
of
two
of
thirds
and
contrapuntal
comes
to
bo
rhythmically
and
toler^
movement can
voices and
every
which
introduced, in
egularly
stand,
a
free
alone
sixths,
other
or
will, in every
With
witli this movement. fundamental.
since
few
intervals
more
the seventh
course,
dmitted
age
makes
development
many
significance
than
^., in fugues.
e.
use,
voices
harmonic
purely
and
them
this
give
polyphonic
movement
possess.
omission
lace
the
a
for other
adapted
actual
movements,
in
movement,
appear
harmonic
individual
that
to
it first receives
contrapuntal of
Movement.
two-voiced
rarely
simply of
monotony
ovement
it
polyphonic
formation
arious
of the
which
for
indeed,
for the fovi^
given
XXII.
Two-Voiced
the
meagreness
labors,
cases
if it
If chords
they
appear
empty
the
chord
instead
of
where occurs
too
of
the
it
and
; the
fourth
chord
sixth of
will generally to be
are
Octaves
the
take
necessarily
triads,
of the seventh
be omitted.
cannot
the
case,
the
fifths
are
could and
applied, seldomr only
fourth
second.
be can
(See
188). P
BtoampU:
i^="
1"
19.
can
sixth
be used.
On
The
were
which
CHAPTER
o
the
eyen
suspension.
For
e
that
proof,
"p^
B"
0
-jO.
i
MANUAL
194
The
omission
amental be
ill
ts situation,
i.
same
^.,
is
Example
of
in connection
rare
The
interyals
of
tones
OF
through
exercise
the
F"
of
this, since
each
preceding
and
0
G
.
a
Want
418.
the following
with
o
through
plain
No. with
HARMONY.
harmony.
following :
marking
0
G
Oa
-s:
^
itself through
explains
chord
fim"
harmony
the
of
clearness
la:
m
2s:
;$:
30.
of the
comparison
Trealmmii:
fJ .^ 6 3
31. 6
6
6
I
-
-
"-"-
1-^
3^^
E -"-
i
13^ 6
4 2
6 P^"y
;}s
Most
of
harmony
the
The
as
well
[^
therefore, as
they to
also
the in
be
afford
consists
at
its
the
is
our
labors
own as
the
to
remains
exercises
the
assumed,
so
form
knowledge that
the
the
o
success
choice. a
time
same
upon
in this, viz. ; that here,
it only
and
use,
trespass
part only
contrapuntal
left to
these
regard
third
the
is prescribed,
certainty can
in
difference
in
while
harmonies
useful an
exercise
preparatory
insight
into
the
relation
counterpoint.
exercises
in
drop
the
they
chords
voices,
the
may,
or those,
The
the as
of
We
exhibited
exercises
of
succession
armony,
noe
the
of
of counterpoint.
eading
f
E
:f:
omain
he
"-
liis:
tne
next
above
chapter
limitation
are
of
also a
to
be
prescribed
considered succession
in this lighi| of chordAi
XXIII.
CHAPTER
annanie
JElabaratian
a
of
Voice
given
Melodic
in
Develop*
mentm
By
development
melodic
icher
ornamentation, variety our
of
better
the
be
understood
exhibited.
Through
to
the
alone
will be avoided,
exercises
develop
to
here
XIX.
measural-divisions
earlier
learn
to
iven
is not
voice
Chapter
as
such
their
of
a
of
voices
thereby
gres pro-
be
opportunity
harmonic
the
of
metrica
choral-like
simple,
and
that
ment accompani-
also.
The
following
this plainer
will make
exercise
:
23. 1^
42-H9-
fe
"*"
-t
*
^
The
of
choice
Even
if the
elodic
leading
e given
n
i^
t
t
s:
the
to
a
the kind
measure
of
the
of
of if
chapters,
previous
be
elaborated,
them,
according
to
free,
a
itself.
treatment
the
itself, produce
will, of
selected
voices
leading
good
is left to
chord-succession
still especial to
the
attention
is
them
of
must
developed
principles
treatment
skillful
like
a
to
be
ttained. This
first in three-voiced
will follow,
exercise
treatment.
33. -"
42h9
3:
ISI :gl
-^^^
E"E
It
^^"
:sri
w "
-P-"-
HP^
t
6
6 3
The
harmonic
6
7
7
order
to
be
able
to
6 4
6 5
^=^^
:^
has
of
be
been farther
no
needs
may
0
g
.
what
treatment
and
i ^
:t
n
-F
after
movement,
any-sidedness,
In
6
7
-I"
"t
hree-voiced
P*-
-"-
-o-
treatment,
"
X
s^s This
(
X
8
9
I
._(SL".
'^
i
this
retain
the
Alto
with
connection
the
explanation. as
melody
recommended
in
remarked
as
voice,
a
middle useful we
will
voice
show
iti
exercise.
transpose
the
melody,
foi
24.
^
^M5
11^ Sie
"^^-^
,^"
p-g.^rrrTFPr ^ift^
3: .a-T
:}sc:-"'-
6
7
The
fourth
the
Y.
the
the
of
hord The
the
of
chord is
sixth
in
found
987
1^
la:
It
degrees,
hy
fourth
and was
what
chords.
passing
Bass
the
of
s
-"-i-
measure,
concerning
rogression
the
of
6
^P-^t
:i"z
explanation
-"-
6
6
583984
""-S-
9-^
1
-fi_".
can^tM^rmtM.
n
in
here,
the
through
accidentally,
stands,
and
Chapter
in
remarked
arose
free
enters
which
the
the
of
place
second.
treatment
the
of
same
to
transferred
eantusfirmus
Bass:
the
435.
It
HSL
g=s:
ferfiir
a=5^
-^-
.|_".._
"
a.
"
t
i
t
t
"*"
a:
^?"
IS.
Ie
6
ff
mv-
6
6
"./.
G-
mt
-"-.-
treatment
ourth
in the
nless
we we
troduce
96.
of
to
passing e.
it
develop and
4 36
6
A
of the
is
a
very
as
a
passing
the
changing
leading notes
6
-
3b
2
"
4
(O
"
6-6
g
-fi"-^
in the
weakness
iT
^
|2-r(a~^
rG-
sustained
explain
to
wish
the
a
.a-i
Ffe
-"2-
measure
sixth
wish
be added,
G-
exhibits
harmonizing
If
^-
""--
This
he
o
""-^"
^
H9-T-
'-"a.
third
Bass.
imperfect
and In
fourth like
i
in
measures,
bare
the
manner
representatiye
a
of
chord,
note.
of
the
Toices
interchangeably,
still farther, into
the
we
two
c^n
Toices
g. c./.
1^
It
jQ^LfL.
*
*-*-^-!y.
!llg
""
-O
E^ I
r=f=f-"^ I i"i I
^
OF
MANUAL
HARMONY.
197
""fa "*"
t^
;#"
ZCZT
p-
1
i
"EE
"
":.^z 6 5
oices
the
treatments,
remaining
will here
be
SEE
"
li-*
7
^-
-#"
9i
Of
3
6
given
s
3Cir
that
the
of
firnvus
cantus
in the
middle
:
^-#
ip:
-^^tf: Sl^
"f^
is:
c./.
|1E
37.
"a"
^"^^
"9-
ar:
6
6
7
6
9
6
6
#-?=^-#
m^^^
t^ifc
" 6
As 438"
w*
:i=p:
examples
"""
3
V-
r2E
8
^^M
X
foar-voiced
"e-
the following
treatment,
1
t
may
stand
0"Mn"o{e".-
^^s-
t:^
22=?
^
6
13 of
#-#"
:c=t
gi^g^=i[i
-(S-
3l 9
-"-
^
-"-
l^^EE
3
jO.
-p-
t
is.
""
e^-ffi t3 h
^^
here
:
OF
MANUAL
98
iT^n^f-
t^-
"-^
^E^
^2-"-
"
HARMONY.
^ESE
""-^
25=:i:
-o"^.
isr"^
\
-"-
"
r"-^
i
'9-
.NB.
teEi?
-"-
II
F=?5:^
:?5=5:
St
^F 6 4
8
9 3
6
^"2"
'
a)
3
7-4
i
gJ-
^
-
6
6
6
_
"""
6
6
"
867
6t)543
^
^
:t=:t NB.
In
ot
fifth
the
measure,
because
good,
cuse
In
this the
The
same
at
the
same
G
Tenor
the
of
skip
fundamental
is found
the
in the
here
Chap.
the
measure
triad,
t stands
the
time,
; only
into a
makes
the
position
the
long
in the
skip
the
of
i
seventh
Alto
can
case.
same
ugmented
NB.,
Soprano,
the
into
direction,
me
at
XII.,
original character
the
of
which
is prepared
suspension
from
fifth of of
a
the
chord
sixth
fourth
and
(pages 91 below.
of
and
the
92)
sions, Suspen-
(See
116).
page
cantusfirmus
in the
Alto,
to
transposed
D
:
majdr
NB.
"
fe" H
^
i.
-""
i
(2.
9
1^-
(:=t
i
c./.
ft
:ai
r*
""^
-"
i
IS.
30.
-fS
nziii:
f
H^ m
"=5t
5 4
? 3
6
6
iife S^E^
A.
.""
8 6 4
"-
f: I
-"-r
I
l^
'ft
^
j(2.
?2=5=
-fl-
pS
i
NB.
3=^
m
i
f
_fi"_".
7
6
3
6
In
17).
s
not
ng^.
fourtli
the
found
are
measure
fifth and
the
because
good^
7
10
^^1=^ In
6
the
measures
sixth
distance
the
in
suspensions
three
from
one
of
the
to
the
Alto
the
of
position
(see page
voices
is
other
Tenor
and
than
more
an
ctave.
Of
the
ere
treatments,
remaining
follow
that
wiU
^^. JSl
fc*
^
"-T
-o-
'^'-^^
S
i
E
I"ferft
fi-i.
^
-"-*"
?5:?^
""-
Hg^
-(a.
E
t 6 4
6 4
3
6
6
"Tai
ife
6
2
6
.2
5^*
6
s=tr
6 4
6
-^t^^^
i
H
-"-
6^3116
"
-"-
4 3
t -"-i"
^
NB.
The
introduction
fourth
iately
f
Bass
:
31.
he
in the
firmus
cantus
Besides the
hords The
the
chord not
(See
seventh.
the
but
tone,
seventh
treatments
of
:
in
the
of
the
same
not
ensue
canius
here
firmus
pages with
68 a
to
according as
manner
cadencing
Cjf07 FJ|. (See
this
imme-
lies
fondamentar
the
in
degree,
seventh
69).
page
does
the
of
seventh
because
clear,
this, its progression
leading of
is
measure,
above
the
of
and
the
with
leading
the
other
69).
leading
of
the
voices
in
00
"./.
S
11^
I3e:
IFE^
w
i
z:
2=5
""-"-
gZ^^e
az
sd.
5d:
Pfc-t=i
^
y?^#^
ti
Ft 6 4
^
fc=p:
6 4
H
-!^
=F
^
-"-
J^l
:r
6 5
6
32:
Hi ff"
."-.
"=;
^
::lfc KB.
^E^
:^
J(SL
^1
"jflL
:t 6 5
l=d:
^pi^
6 6
2
%
4 3
7
6
^^^g
i
3 -"-
The
upward
(at NB.), The
33.
is conditioned
treatment
l^
^
of
progression
of
the
by
the
cantus
3="^^3
the
seventh
movement
jirmus
in the of
in the
the
to
next
the
Soprano.
Tenor
last
(See
measure
page
84)
follows:
n
3:
t
-"-
3s:
1^^
^-0-W-
" ^scz:^: ^"
1-2"
a-^
6
iitt
:p:
?^
G
6
6
6 -"-
"JSL
"
-g
at-
i
t
:i^ 111^ fr
m
"
-"-r
g
6 4
6
^r=X=^i
:|:
^
3=^-? -"-i.
The
thijd
in
measure
contrary
e
to
the
character this
motion;
while
of
those
7th
the
of
true
from
sion fifth-succes-
and
each
following
the
and motion,
parallel
much which
other,
make
by
milder
ever, how-
the
contrary
each
approach
Example
also
they
that
fifth-succcessions,
the
those
it is to
and
octave-successions,
rendered
(See
Tenor
the
; with
of
27
page
with
is
perceptible.
following
of
voices
separation
between
on
connection
progress
more
the
those
as
particularly
measures,
Compare
in
of
which
connection
and
faulty
as
movement
is
developed
principle
remarked free
the
confine
the
just
are
especially
octave
of
speak
motion.
According they
to
opportunity
gives
i
^1
"9-
6 4
1
^-i.
1^-
eTe
m-
'-(s:
-"-
-"-
m
pages,
or
separation
No.
430
other
in
wan
the
6th
Bass).
and :
examples
la: -"-
-jy
^
2=^J
-bzP^^g"
-^
434.
:^
-"-
""
G_.
"
"*"
"6h
If
we
at
the
melodic
for regarding
ssence
of
them
but
with
the a
given
labors
in
the
distinction the
harmonic
in this
from freer
laws,
we
chapter,
voices, ; for
-G-
and
herein
lies the ground
in
consists
exactly
the
the
monic rhythmical-har-
leading latter
which
this
purely
melodic
fail to
cannot
of
form,
the
voices,
it
as
were,
substance. in
now
in quarter thus
contrapuntal
of the
observance
Everywhere
and
of
it conditions
viz., that
its innermost
ove
as
development
counterpoint,
form,
found
treatments
the
glance
ecognize
of
I
T=l^'
they
the
notes, serve
may
difference voice.
these
The
more
simply
the
between
examples, harmonic
purpose, simply
particular
in
even
for
those can
structure
the
present,
harmonic
discussion
of
the
where
making
of
this
can
us
stand under-
treatment
contrapuntal
and
voices
be demonstrated,
only
be
takes
XXiy.
CHAPTER Five-Voiced
The
As
doubliDg
the
four-y Diced
becomes
the
a
the
of
chords
Since
in
the
doubling,
lers
this
Farther
sake
than
five- voiced
degree,
except
this
and
a
each
be
sure,
which
in
even
ih"
i
movements
in
even
take
can
; the
of
admit
place
the
case
o
as,
for
double
a
with
sion, progres-
capable
least in
of
interval
each
example,
it
maintain
be
will be
seventh
leading,
melodic
must
voice
independence,
this
attaining
circumstances
where
adapted
passing,
o
for ren-
necessary.
reduplication
follow
remarks
movement,
especially
of to
certain
under
chord
intervals
This,
eduplication.
is necessary
more
still greater
harmonic
pure
those for
a
triad
seventh.
the
independence, will,
in
a
of
in five and
so
moyement,
necessity
intervals
the
of
Movement.
in connection
with
the examples
^iven.
Fxerdse. 6 5
6
485.
In
the
ither
two
^
""g
^
:s:
treatment,
t
can
we
Sopranos,
two
select, according
Altos
4 3
2
6
or
^tt
g
5=F
to
the
position
of
the
Tenors.
two
436. SOPBANa
l
fe-^C
:5=^
-fl:
a
W-Q"^AiffoL
;;o
"ltoII.
;;o
TnroB.
l^-\
^"x-t\""^
g
-"--
isiz.
?2=S: 1
^
-"-
6L
6
S^
;^
4
6 6^
6 221
is:
2
3
voisof^
The
same
carried
exercise
in
out
:
manner
another
437. tOrSAlTO
m.
m
I.
"
^ ^"2^
s
:"_:
I
tOPBAKOlL
g
"-
-"
1
? ""
!""
"
SL
s
Ifo
ALTa
:^
"^
TnroB.
-"-
^
^E -F 4
6
6
6 .6
m
Bass.
It
not
pertains
regain
In
above
between
the
same
The
^
'r-="-
X
to
also
is the
this
Soprano leaves
only
t=F the
of in the
or
in
case
but
its position,
that
voices,
octave,
first
the but
Tenor,
and
however
case,
tone
one
upon
second
following
independence
the
example,
chord
is:-
1-ZJS.
stationary
the
he
I
v
3
2
here
if
the
voices
measures
faulty,
not
for
is exchanged
no
d"
change.
chords
second
and is
two
because
other.
:
43".
ould
be
corrected
thus
:
P
Q.
439.
!
if3 RsvABK.
honic
That
eading
he
"
^This rale
movements,
leading
the tone,
second
of
is shown
Soprano
and
:S
i' t
however,
there
the
by
;^
(2-
-"
/_a:
admits,
because
^
i^
other
of
relations
voices
the
Tenor.
frequent
third
will
present
also
measure
ezoeptioDS
with
polj-
themselves.
admit of
in connection
of
Example
the
doubling No.
487,
of the between
204
five and
fifths, octaves
must
in
voices
The
unisons
and
progress
middle
five-voiced
than
more
pure
only,
following
movement,
tbe
appear.
That
will
a
and
relations,
be mentioned
may
contains
example
nnavoidableness
greater
here
the
also
be
freedom
of
covered
outer
voices to
allowed
tbe
again.
various
of
progressions
this sort
:
440 BOPBANO
IL
Alto
I.
Alto
II.
U'
-^
-("-V-
Si^
"
"
""
i^
jg^gj
:t=i5F
i
B
-"-
i
"
fS^*
Iffi.
isz.
P"
--G
ifz^ 7
6 5
"^^ The
covered
by
indicated
second
of
jsl
Iffil
l^-""-
::3::zs::
7
6
251
;i3L
:5=^
-"-
6 4
7
-"-
t^
/!!
8 t
6 4
8
6
?2=":
m
js:
xz::
-"-
Bam.
-"-
JSL
i^i
Tbnob.
^^
^
9
the
Alto
?2:
fifth, octave
and
The
open
is not
to
strokes. and
diminished
Bass
seventh
can,
3
unison
progressions
fifth in
the
be
avoided,
only
with
eighth
since
in
this
measure,
example
are
between
the
tbe
polyphonically
difficulty, be
made
to
chord
progress
otherwise.
The
first and
second
Altoh* in the
eighth
and
following
measurej
could
rs
g"
I
1
-G-
441. 31
a=^r
That
the
Toices,
is shown
other
by
Of
^
g
9
"
particularly
the
middle
the
Alto
and
second
voices, Tenor
must
in
cross
often
the
second
each
third
and
easures.
For
in the
practice
five-voiced
movement,
chorals
be
can
especially
used
o advantage.
The
following
Choral:
^
AUein
Oott
in
here
given Hdh'
der
G
set
:
Ehr*.
G
"
Ga
DODij'GDij'Os
^
"
-"
*""
^
be
may
"-
-"
-"-
'^
5iE"E?^BS P "
G
"
D.
El
"
bO
"
-fi
'^-
I
=F=t G
0
D
^
^-
s
-"-:
E
bOa*
?5:=^
t=t SI/
A
:i=^
B
"
B
-"-
\
O-
-g
G
D
-"-
:^
A
D.
G
"
1
-o-fi-
X
:F=t:=:
r:
VA/ \sy
The
work
imple
and
atter,
so
oices,
The
the
the
much
of very
five
clearer
will become the
the
necessity can
progressions
unintelligible
of
the
and
intelligible
more
this exercise
the
requires
succession
free
the
of
easily
since movement
arise.
:
443.
r
1 si
SL *
J. *
\" J
J
-
J
"
*^
a)
J
f
1=! I
6
'
t
^
m
I 6 \"y
a
difficult the
and
important,
more
here
follows
movement
less artificial
the
and
is here
; this
chords
beginning
and
five-voiced
than
more
and
Bass-progression,
natural
itself
ullness
in
6
of
mony har-
with
the
of
th*
444.
CHAPTER
The
oices
are
which
harmonic
simplest
undamental
nner
o
be
a
of
definite
ltered A
few
because
the
and
Progression
to
the
the
second
not
0
"
"-
chords
are
not as
a
the
follow
may
number
cross
as,
movements,
all for
at
they
are
this
subject
for example,
the
seventh. here.
:
thvoieed:
^"voiced:
"
i:
3=^
-g"
a!
i
'=g
*
I
-ffi. -o^
"-
^
45.
JSL "
"*^
-*" "
"
ig -"-
-"-
-"-
-SL
l-ffoieed
8~9oiefd:
:
0
:g:
ifc
1
J: -oar
^-_
^t
other degree,
still greater
as
with
each
adapted
much
the
of
connection
polyphonic
such
in
of
chord
degree
in
of multiplication,
allow
triad
^-voiced: ._
of
in
voices
here,
intervals,
diminished of
progressions
many
their
do
the
become
possibility
that
progression,
chords
the
of
that
voices,
the
with
occur
often
also
progressions
remarked,
writing,
will
the
of
condition
it must
nd
it
MavemenU
increases
trebling
or
added; leading
Eight^oiced
and
doubliDg
of
necessity
independent
he
Seven
Six,
The
XXV.
""-
^
i
^ "
^
m
(o: "
,
Progression
to
the
degree
ihird
:
fk-fwleed:
5-w"ie"d:
4H"o{o0"t.*
m
7-iKneed:
6-9oic4d:
I ^"
I
"jsr.
"
9
9
"
'
9
"-
g
^r=^
g-
I^I^g^^S
W=^-^-{-^^-^r^ Progression
to
the
fourth
^
I
:s:
*
9^
Progression
degree
:
d-vaieed:
t^-9"dced:
4Hooic6d:
"="":
to
the
^
i
I -gg-
-g9-
tt.
i
-G
3C
B'Votcsd:
*
1
i^
3::
-^-
-09-
-"-
12^:
^
1
l-voteid:
^"wdecd:
I
^
::ss:
:
6-w"fced:
^t-fwiced:
* ":
fifth degree
S-9aio"d:
1
jGS.
g
o
J-wdeed:
^^
jsr.
g
g^
js:
l^crScrt
5152:
1
-OL
-C-g-3-
We
e of As
ound
pass
over
great
nse.
the
of
example
No.
nnder
may
here
follow
try them,
leading
the
of
management
442,
; to
combinations
I
t4 I" "
I
II.
P
S
Aiaok
g
9
I
I
^
'
with
of
six voices
with
440.
vmAKo
imom
f"rther
fS
I
m
v^
:
^
!" 4-,-J "=?2 g:
1
t
?5i:
I
I
3fc=t :p 6
6
6 6
J -"
3fe -"-
m
choral
t
L_i XL
the
^S
""--^"^
I. A
voices,
will
/TN
J: ~0
the
all inversions,
l=t
"
:?c:
'"fH'-
?
1=t
^
::i
^
-"
J-4-mJ-s! f 1?:^
d-J-"-J"
"J-
"=!St
-"
^
"
f=F
3:
3^
:S2=?2:
""-
t=P
N
^=i
i
6
6
*
"-
r
T
t
T
f
6 4
6
"=q
-"-
"
r-^~^
:^
^
^bd
3
m
-"sa/
^7\
nS^
4
J*
J zt.
E
v-
r
^
U^^
"^"
is:
4.
J
d=i I
J=d:
1-
J"
4.
I "
ii;
F=f
"^
-"
f 3:
5^1
1 "
S
:^
r 6
!"-
6
f 7 4
6
--
i:
^=F
vj/
S
EE
^i^ "
ti
6 6
3
-
(2
(
7 6i]
7
g-
"l-^
-"-
:g
i
6
IS. -"-
"-
3
^: s"/
^
"-
tn
\SJ
in polyphonic
Since the
t
time,
same
nly
three
he
accession
The
assing
ess
and
a
of
can
show,
very
movement
of
always
work
often
appears
intensity
through
voices.
will
explain
that
in
this kind
polyphonic
introduced,
be
well
do not
voices
increase
an
receives
and
number
to
the
choral-treatment,
examples
serve
notes
as
a
of
following
specially
in
four-voiced,
and
all the
chorus-movements,
of
work
chorus-movement also,
suspensions
detriment
without
and
to
and
the
clear
intelligibility.
447.
ti I
Soprano
9
"
"""
2.
\^
Iifcll.
"uro.
1 "
-S--
;iii2=
lai -"-
-"-
u
SNOR
IdsIL
""
WS:
^:^;r=f-g
"^;^zr.
^-^ -9"
is:
9'g==
abs.
I
I
"
"at
ip-5
"5
3C
! J
tM
f-
r
^
T-g
W yg
""-
"^^h ^z: "
"-
""
"
"
"
aO
i
""
-g"-
fziit^"=t:S :p^
is
"
:?"
:??:
?aL ,
"-
lEi
*=!:
^-i ii
:a:
35':
::a:
J-J
jS.
-"-
^ 31
\
J^=-Jiji
s:
as: -("-
W.
210
44
MANUAL
".
BorxAvoI.
80FEAN0
"lto.
AlvoIL
Tbkos.
BABBi
II.
L
OF
HARUONT.
feii
-^""
^
i
"
E
-"-
IJ
hhi-^TA]
-"-*-
^
-#"
^"EIE
I
s
f
SJzzisti:
"-
"
-"-i.
"5=*
"
^5
i
?5:
tfe g
9-f
"-T-
:??:
ri
7g
"F=t
I
IE
:?5:
i
E In
our
are
voices
requently
two
opranos,
nly As
Altos,
often
in single an
passages
example
ust
make,
the
ight
voices
:
of
which
kind Tenors
two
or
latter
the
of like
four,
appears
into
divided
oices
voices,
voices
two
ovement
twice,
used
independent
ight
for which,
ohorus-movements,
eighirvoiced
are
not
two
in
Basses
which
We work
the
found too
cause
six-voiced.
choirs,
rule,
customary
as
employed
but
fullness,
great
in unison
employed and
a
always
easily
would
five and
different
two
are
as
(forexample, unison), so find
each
also
tw"
that the
the
eight
for itself, and
together. the
beginning
particular of
the
progression
choral
given
which
above
many may
of
these
follow
voices
here
for
449.
PKAHO
Auo
Tterom
Boi
L
I. A
L
1. *
II.
A
IL
A
IL
U.
m
MANUAL
12
HARMONT
OF
^
^
rss
#=q
""-"
^"=t=t J
4"4.
*
1
"ss-
f^ i
"
"-
-"
Ptrf:
^Ts:
32"
I
2S"
i
^
"t=F "-
H
^
s
331:
t=F
J
i
J
I "
1
iS f
t
I
The
difficulty
vements
two
or
ifference,
be
o
but
is generally
een-voiced
choruses,
found,
voices hints
These
he
rest,
onal
ts
are
ation
the
and
and
g.j in orchestral
ufficient,
the
in
still be
will
majority the
subject
us
of
cases,
farther
(even other
to
can
if often
which,
here
may
six only
instru
shown,
the
suppose) the
four-voiced of
information,
the
have
compass
only
since manner
appli
so
of
part
th"
however man}
adduced
will be
movement
which
per
of
music,
taking
in the
use
will
instrumental
(as the
to
Concerninj,/
movements.
above
; in
suffice, sinc%
left
be
can
that
approaching
principles.
Bach
of
however,
remark
treatment
give
or
obligate.
polyphonic
find place
allows
in th
place
of twelve
pieces
harmony,
of
choirs
not
; it is alway
takes
single
movement
farther
for
kinds
to
treated
for may
tonicai
the
voices
speak
(among
of treatment
instrumentation
of reduplication
and
polyphonic
manner
works,
concerning
nstruction
ost
its
we
the
we
when
voices
inclination
of varioui
last, in
etc.,
knowledge
in compositions
mostly
or this
the
by this, that
changes.
reckoned), are
however,
form
nstruments
be
polyphonic
met
succession
understood
more
and
thorough
application,
olyphonic
be
movements,
concerning
with
study
to
in rapid to
eight
where
harmonic
the
of
altogether
separates
which
case
choirs,
it is not
together,
that
the
different
two
metrical,
never
and
above
ental
the
is, in
writing
into
work
however,
manner,
The
choirs
often
presumed,
implest
e
more
of
manner
divided
are
which
here
this
of
the
here
shown
actiuU
th^ relations
aboTe)
XXVI.
CHAPTER On
Several
n
kinds to
relation
53 ; in the
nd
has
hese
been
forms
The
authentic
The
plagalic
V-i,
:
Both
ut
If
the
treatise,
the
however, that
subject, so here
may
follow
fuller
40
pages
farther
no a
on
opportunity
qf
explanation
:
divided
into
e.
parts,
discussion
a
it
piece,
(or in
in
compositions,
whole
the
this
page
seldom
composition
of
of
of to,
referred a
concludes
close ; in
lY-I
close
plagal
conclusions
principal
book
the
the
at
particular
(See
the
remarked.
only
the
of
more
authentio
major,
not
Y-I,
formula
the
before
was
close
close
plagal
to
whole
followed
83)
and
close.
has
used
Form.
of
the
eads
are
The
octrine
flsu'ther remarks
up
(pages 32
mentioned
close,
immediately
plagal
close
the
ivisions.
Close.
of
been
already
close
are
iv-i),as
at
also
Forms
close and or
kinds
take of
close
authentic
inor
to
kinds
of
the
of
given
The
The
authentio
course
other
and
have
close
of
the
Musical
the
periods,
and
belongs
point
their to
the
142). stands
alone,
it also
minor
but
succeeds
frequently
g.
avih,
plaffol
close
close
450.
In
last
the
case,
as
in the
example,
above
it is introduced
by
a
means
of
half
closes
odulation. The
closes
(cadences)are
divided
also
into
and
whole
'^cadences). By
the
uthentic
s again
first is understood cadences.
made
between
In
the
the case
perfect and
same
of
which the whole
imperfect
is
comprehended
cadences ones.
a
farther
under
the
distinction
andamentals tonic,
the
f
e,
dominant
the
of
tonio,
and
Soprano
the
and
fondamental
the
g, not:
451.
I
^ ""-
If this is not
tlie
they
case,
are
imperfect, e.
called
g.
i:
I
":
-"-
"t 6 6
53. 6
^F=g=
wO"
Bass
the
alled
from
progresses
deceptive
i
M=fN'=J
2s: jO-
If
"
dominant
the
to
another
degree,
they
are
cadences.
i
m
"
-"
-^
453. 6
^^1
^^
See The
the
examples,
82
pages
half-cadences have
the
to
85.
formula
I-V,
e.
g.
g^Ej^Eg
454.
7y
V
They
therefore
consist
in
this ; that
dominant
the
triad
completes
the
precede
the
ovement.
Besides
ominant
the
tonic
triad,
formation
in the
n
V
other of
a
niy
chords half-close,
V
degrees
other
of e,
IV
can
g.
V
"""" VI
w
tyminani
owever,
the
its
degree,
eventh
e.
in
definite
a
same
the
; with
manner,
the
of
chord
which^ through
effected
harmony
dominant
through
or
the
the
of
but
seventh,
of
seventh
Q:
I
vn"iy
is, however,
This
mmediately For
farther
hich
are
In
No.
ormed
in or
Example
key
the
adence,
the
No.
is
key,
ruling
has
which
kinds
third
fourth
and the
close
half
a
measures
cadence
first division
the
of
of
however,
measures,
eighth
and
those
compare
cadences,
of
book.
this
of
found
I-V,
dominant
half- cadence,
a
a
and the
at
in
perfect whole the
of
the or
third
the
find
we
seventh
fourth
and
cadence
authentic
(Thus
conclusion.
harmony
dominant
the
since
the
ii^i^
cadence.
through the
of
to
o:
of.
seventh
392
V
C:
relation
effects
which
Ad
vii^iy
of these
the
authentic
formed
asures,
use
examples in
n-V,
perfect whole
in
only
made
is found
period;
In
been
in the
through
hole
case
understanding
found 388
o:
"
the
before
the
the
g.
i^i^^ji^^Ega
"..
n
inversions
into
modulation
the
of
position
through
ither
a
itself is not,
modulation
fundamental
he
by
formed
are
which
216
HARMONY.
OF
MANUAL
this
is
half
no
tiie modulation
renders
decided). In
the
mperfect
hird
under
No.
whole
cadence,
the
second
AaZ/'-cadence in G-
cadence
sixth
perfect The
re
f
treated
a
with
hole
he
choral
with whole
the
a
herefore
to
art of the
in Q-
cadence the
of
as
be used
well with
Form-construction
as
ends
an
with
a
2i
perfect whole
cadence
in
the
seventh
(iv-V), and
minor
a
minor, with
major.
various
they
e
first strophe
the cadence, perfect whole (iv-V), the fourth with a perfec
minor
in
the
with
the fifth with
pieces
smallest,
e
major, half cadence
application
extended
to
446,
cadences
form of
the the
of
a
means
more
care,
much
is easily of
piece.
boundary
extended
because
found
upon
in and
chorals;
connection
movements,
tiiem
for
depends
and a
are
great
INDEI
^""
fig^urated,
^campanimenit
lto,
23
harmonio
rHs,
138,
107,
adence,
81
65,
as
hord,
hal( 178,
208.
218;
imperfect^
perfect^
62, 218;
aonneetioii
m
160.
149,
196.
206.
175,
exercises,
21.
h^rd'/omiations,
hords,
^iord
the
of
sixth
with
nection
of the
hord
sixth
triad,
of
second,
of
the
sixths
of
the
seventh,
fourth
diminished,
of
the
of
the
sixth,
of of
the eleventh,
ontrary
fourth tones,
alteration,
87,
m
158.
188.
189
; augmented,
97;
the
67, 61, 82, 144;
6ft
78, 90,
200.
second). seventh,
64,
188. 68,
in connection
90;
of the 81,
with
146;
in
the
phoni poly-
78 ; in oonnectioD
with
modulation,
88, 54
26,
same
86
; view
of the
themselves, same,
100.
94.
of
the sixth,
fourth
90.
(see chord
of the
seventh).
91.
186.
among
90.
third, chord
and
17 ; complete, motion,
triad,
same,
155,
suspension,
of the
of
chord
major,
degrees,
88,
thirteenth,
the
onsonance,
in
47 ; augmented,
the
of four
dominant
79,
tone
of
hromatic
54;
connection
seventh,
of other
chords
of the
use
63 ;
204.
movement,
hords
as
same
(see Chord
in passing,
76,
;
dose,
68.
degree
seventh
189
diminished
of the
147.
second
same
the
formation
chord,
of the
62;
and
21,
; the
64
61,
59,
passing
60,
in the
same
198;
modulation,
with
seyenth.
as
92,
99.
same,
yiewof
; the
48 *,
fifth,69,
and
the
of the
143
modulation,
in connection
sential,
of the
fourth,
and
188;
passing,
Chords
augmented
the
of
101;
91,
Triads,
also
106.
accidental,
48,
altered, see
hord
168,
86,
118.
horals,
hord
34,
same,
148.
antutJirmuSf
hord
of the
128.
formuloB,
eUf,
elet, 118.
progression
; whole,
modulation,
adence
hord
roioe^ 151 ; 17S;
giren
174.
harmonic,
y-tones,
hord
a
121.
Bass, 23 ; movement,
hord
to
aooompaniment
121.
tooes,
alto
notes,
; alto
nticipation,
hord
; hannomo
188
195.
fter-striking of
hord
SUBJECTS.
OF
incomplete,
17.
and
third, 69, 60^ t%
MANUAL
onnection
lose^
82
; authentic, see
losing
losing
also
ross-relation,
eceptive
cadeDe"b
149.
41,
166^
unharmonifl^ 81.
diatonic,
igression
18.
(see Modulation).
issonance,
17.
ominant
harmony,
leventh,
G-triad,
of the
chord
in connection
seyenth
with
144.
modulatioii,
14.
xercises,
for
of the
the
practice
78 ; of
seventh,
connection
; of other
112,
163,
altered
166,
187, to
accompaniment voiced
a
202,
movement,
192;
191,
ke3rs,
or
out
development
of the
two-voiced
in melodic
chords
of the
of the
augmented
87 ;
108
modulation, to
a
development,
196,
sions, suspen-
200
167,
162,
in the
193;
movement,
triad
in the
;
i
seventh
161,
177
melody,
o
of th9
the
; of
voice,
given
of
inversions
the
of
chord
themselves,
among
seventh
8^
chords
secondary
.the
77 ;
major,
dominant
; of the
secondary
in the
voice
given
; of the
accompaniment
173;
172,
in minor,
; in searching
harmonic
171,
chords
degrees
tone
98
chords,
170,
86
; of
of the
in
all triads
of
;
triads, 49 68
same,
seventh
cadences,
of other
the
of
movement,
voiced
of the
30
major, of the
of the of the
connection
chords
chords
119;
164,
inversions
deceptive
with
inversions
; of the
the
secondary
80 ; of the
same,
46
in
triads
primary
; of the
68
seventh,
*IA:\ of the
the
of
in minor,
triads
of the
94
40,
cadence^
egrees,
deceptive
half dose,
dose,
whole
81.
66,
ccidence,
85.
umer,
88.
82,
plagal,
cadence,
fomvidcB,
local,
78, 81;
26,
of chordBf
217
HARMONY.
;
thre^harmonic
in the
five
60
fift
206 .
ifteenth^ 14
ifth, 18,
22
in the
16,
; perfect,
of the
chord
16
48,
44,
ourteenth,
ourth,
68,
166;
the
of
undamental
same
as
28,
with
79, 97 ;
61,
passing
and
111,
15,
16,
88,
;
80,
open,
changing
78 ;
notes,
covered,
138;
in
80,
87
contrary
128.
189,
chord,
21
; in the
armony,
tones
foreign
division
see
also
13
;
steps
of)
major, and
above,
18.
of the
chord
184,
186.
alterations seventh,
of the
91"
same^
57.
106.
of the
same,
16, 18 ; inversion
of the
reduplication.
18.
perfect,
skips,
perfect
218.
to the,
omission,
doctrine
of the
preparation
196.
; chromatic
of, 17 ; view
16;
16,
56.
68,
(half cadence), 178, 21.
ntervals,
diminished,
(fourth parallels)in passing,
21
close
ntervals
68,
augmented,
harmonies,
armony,
nterval
68,
the close, 89,
undam"ntal,
nterval,
connection
64,
perfect,
ormation
ntervals,
; diminished,
14.
13;
ourth-progressions
alf
76
201.
motion,
iguring,
in
204;
168,
16,
67, 70.
seventh,
ifth-progressions(parallelfifths),26, 110,
15,
; augmented,
14;
augmented
minor,
and
augmented,
dimimshed,
diminished, 156.
ICu
same,
lH
fo1lrtl
Invenion^
of the triadi, 4*7 ; of the
47;
Leading
ST, 89,
tone,
Major
22,
triads
Melody
76, 116,
66,
its development,
22,
88,
102
; means
triad,
Modulation^
Movement,
202
parallel,
NaehaatZj
177. 14
Ninth,
chord
;
18
168,
oblique,
and
148.
completion,
four-voiced,
187;
three-voiced,
28;
Art*
80^ 86^
ft
206.
15.
118,
127.
11.
voices,
diminished,
in contrary
208;
123.
188,
16.
16,
26,
28;
110,
30,
open,
188;
oorered,
201.
motion,
78,
67,
198.
184.
128,
notes,
passing
138.
chords, 177.
lagal
41,
close, 38,
osition
the
of
reparation,
rime,
of
triads,
unison,
in
33
chords
of
(in major)
39,
40.
156.
the
70,
68,
96,
seventh, of the
73, 81 ; of the
""c. ; connection 48,
(in minor) 74;
66;
66,
seventh,
dominant
of the
107.
suspension,
; in minor,
fifth progressions
chord
114
82,
16.
166,
26,
81,
64.
unmelodic,
of intervals,
seventh
64,
28,
major,
octave,
of the
of the 16,
seventh,
secondary
eduplication,
esolution,
70;
augmented, the
melodic,
of the
dispersed,
open,
seventh,
perfect,
rogression,
close,
chord,
chord
rimary
218.
of the
13;
rimary
cale
1*77*
26.
(octave parallels),
Outer
enod,
198;
eight-voiced,
and
augmented,
of intervals,
assing
I t
26.
Organ-point,
tiss;
also
118.
; perfect,
Omission
seven
88,
of the,
Octave^rogreasions 84,
formatioii,
; its extension
141
same^
two-voiced,
184;
minor,
major,
movement,
Octave,
for the
contrary,
Ninth'SuepenHon,
Oblique
(see
65.
; six,
Movement,
Ninths
19
208.
176 ; its rhythmioal
one-voiced,
voiced,
62,
28.
voices^
Minor
69,
seventh,
66.
y
Middle
169,
of the
chords
109,
66,
111,
see
also
chords. 182,
202,
; of the
60
basi
resolution,
chords
secondary
106,
suspension,
206.
109,
116,
of the
120.
(see Triads).
econdary
triads, in
econdary
chords
econd,
13
;
econd,
of the
step
equence,
the
of
major,
econd-progressions
major,
ignatures,
78, 86. 16,
augmented,
(second
16.
in passing, paralleb),
augmented,
184;
with
changing
notes,
180.
44.
(seventh parallels),in
major,
without 13
64,
42.
37.
13;
same
ixth,
; in minor,
seventh.
minor,
eventh-progressions
eventh,
33
;
major, 63.
minor,
preparation, minor,
diminished,
16,
72, 77,
augmented,
168,
16,
16.
passing, 16; 164.
184;
passing,
with
changing
72, 176;
notes,
preparation,
136.
70;
the
OF
MANUAL
toHonafy
voices, 123,
trttcture,
tyle,
ttbdominant
117, 14.
enor,
28
; tenor
diminished,
21 ;
major, minor (in connection 34,
with
in the
chord
of the
166,
seyenth,
57
28
(in major)
142
;
; subdominant
; harsh-diminished,
96,
96
(in minor)
triad,
40
; tonie
triad
28.
48,
; augmented,
66,
92
ished, ; dimin-
66. 21,
major
scale,
of the
minor
scale,
43,
88,
40,
42,
99.
46,
99
; natural
connection
of the
22
same,
; view
99.
46,
same,
triad
modulation) 94
60,
48,
88,
; dominant
22
;
of the
the
16;
142.
double-diminished,
Hade^
16,
(see Figuring).
notation
triady 23,
28
Toieei|
14.
horough-base
Had,
in sereral
116;
upwards,
cle^ 113.
major, minor, (see Leading tone).
hirteenth,
onic
tenor
notes,
22;
18,
70
below
from
111;
138.
107,
hird,
bass.
199.
hith,
%e8is,
187.
pure,
; in the
108
106,
24;
28.
triad,
ttepension,
187,
24,
strict, free,
pure,
J19
126.
harmonic,
pure
HARMONY.
70, 169.
ritonue,
ioelfth,14.
nison^
18.
nison
progressionSj
oices,
movemeot
oices,
of the,
compass
of the,
oices,
relation
of the,
oices,
outer,
ordenatz,
23
;
161,
27 ; covered, 26,
206.
;' (see Progression,
66
113. 113.
middle
Yoices,
28
; deyelopment
of the
a
accompanying
14S.
rmces,
174.
NOW
IN
PRESS.
RICHTER'S
A
Ae,),
MANUAL OF
SIMPLE
AND
DOUBLE
COUNTERPOINT; BBSfO
TEXT-BOOK the
same
kidiBpensable
of
the
inytilxiable
aid
to
greatest
practical the
interest
"v^oifck:.
DPiF^HSHibvrr
the
to
seiqtjeiij
THB
and
characteristics
importance
which
have
to
STUDnrrs
rendered
the
of
Uubic,
Manual
of
exhibiting HAXtMon
Teacher.
(B99
nemt
Pmg9")
o
VALUABLE
AIDS TO
THE
STUDY
RicHTER's
OF
Manuals. """
or
BY
J.
P.
MORGAN
AND
O.
B.
BOISE.
-"#"-
^NQRAVED ITET
2"Tos.
Separate ^ctayo ^HEET^
i}i
2,
1,
FBICE,
3
4,
10 CENTS
A-NTID
FEB
S
SHEET.
FLE
DSrO"W
A
'O'?',
"""
Kos. partments erdses
1 and of
2 contain Elementary to
additional
Exerdses Music
those
given
upon
Intervals, The
teaching. in
the
following
Manuals,
references
to
the
corresponding
in all d"
use
great
contain
numbers
Ex
with
|!k4 ^Hw^^ 1^1 i\t mt\ and
of
Exercises
nH %
and
ppil$"
explanatory
matter
of
the
Manuals. These
Sheets
Iirice for any
GO
-^rr
number
fl
5^ /7sr CONTROL
or
sent
by
numbers
m^l,
postage
ordered*
OO.
BOOKBINOINa
aMMMMAL
be
will
COS MAMK
m^' "o o
o
r^
paid,
upon
receipt
of
the
net
"iiii 3
klQS
ftcej?"
016
CECIL
H.
STANFORD
GREEN
LIBRARY
LIBRARIES
UNIVERSITY
STANFORD,
94305-6004
CALIFORNIA
(650)
723-1493
[email protected] All
books
are
DATE
^ r
^^^4
^fH
4 200/
2003
^^j
subject DUE
to
recall.